daily update
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / breakpoint.c
1 /* Everything about breakpoints, for GDB.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1986, 1987, 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
4 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007,
5 2008, 2009, 2010, 2011 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6
7 This file is part of GDB.
8
9 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
10 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
11 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
12 (at your option) any later version.
13
14 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
15 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
16 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
17 GNU General Public License for more details.
18
19 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
20 along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
21
22 #include "defs.h"
23 #include "arch-utils.h"
24 #include <ctype.h>
25 #include "hashtab.h"
26 #include "symtab.h"
27 #include "frame.h"
28 #include "breakpoint.h"
29 #include "tracepoint.h"
30 #include "gdbtypes.h"
31 #include "expression.h"
32 #include "gdbcore.h"
33 #include "gdbcmd.h"
34 #include "value.h"
35 #include "command.h"
36 #include "inferior.h"
37 #include "gdbthread.h"
38 #include "target.h"
39 #include "language.h"
40 #include "gdb_string.h"
41 #include "demangle.h"
42 #include "annotate.h"
43 #include "symfile.h"
44 #include "objfiles.h"
45 #include "source.h"
46 #include "linespec.h"
47 #include "completer.h"
48 #include "gdb.h"
49 #include "ui-out.h"
50 #include "cli/cli-script.h"
51 #include "gdb_assert.h"
52 #include "block.h"
53 #include "solib.h"
54 #include "solist.h"
55 #include "observer.h"
56 #include "exceptions.h"
57 #include "memattr.h"
58 #include "ada-lang.h"
59 #include "top.h"
60 #include "wrapper.h"
61 #include "valprint.h"
62 #include "jit.h"
63 #include "xml-syscall.h"
64 #include "parser-defs.h"
65 #include "cli/cli-utils.h"
66
67 /* readline include files */
68 #include "readline/readline.h"
69 #include "readline/history.h"
70
71 /* readline defines this. */
72 #undef savestring
73
74 #include "mi/mi-common.h"
75
76 /* Arguments to pass as context to some catch command handlers. */
77 #define CATCH_PERMANENT ((void *) (uintptr_t) 0)
78 #define CATCH_TEMPORARY ((void *) (uintptr_t) 1)
79
80 /* Prototypes for local functions. */
81
82 static void enable_delete_command (char *, int);
83
84 static void enable_once_command (char *, int);
85
86 static void disable_command (char *, int);
87
88 static void enable_command (char *, int);
89
90 static void map_breakpoint_numbers (char *, void (*) (struct breakpoint *,
91 void *),
92 void *);
93
94 static void ignore_command (char *, int);
95
96 static int breakpoint_re_set_one (void *);
97
98 static void clear_command (char *, int);
99
100 static void catch_command (char *, int);
101
102 static int can_use_hardware_watchpoint (struct value *, int);
103
104 static void break_command_1 (char *, int, int);
105
106 static void mention (struct breakpoint *);
107
108 /* This function is used in gdbtk sources and thus can not be made
109 static. */
110 struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
111 struct symtab_and_line,
112 enum bptype);
113
114 static void breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR, CORE_ADDR, int, int);
115
116 static CORE_ADDR adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
117 CORE_ADDR bpaddr,
118 enum bptype bptype);
119
120 static void describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *,
121 struct program_space *, CORE_ADDR,
122 struct obj_section *, int);
123
124 static int breakpoint_address_match (struct address_space *aspace1,
125 CORE_ADDR addr1,
126 struct address_space *aspace2,
127 CORE_ADDR addr2);
128
129 static int watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
130 struct bp_location *loc2);
131
132 static void breakpoints_info (char *, int);
133
134 static void watchpoints_info (char *, int);
135
136 static int breakpoint_1 (char *, int,
137 int (*) (const struct breakpoint *));
138
139 static int breakpoint_cond_eval (void *);
140
141 static void cleanup_executing_breakpoints (void *);
142
143 static void commands_command (char *, int);
144
145 static void condition_command (char *, int);
146
147 typedef enum
148 {
149 mark_inserted,
150 mark_uninserted
151 }
152 insertion_state_t;
153
154 static int remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *, insertion_state_t);
155 static int remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *, insertion_state_t);
156
157 static enum print_stop_action print_it_typical (bpstat);
158
159 static enum print_stop_action print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs);
160
161 static int watchpoint_check (void *);
162
163 static void maintenance_info_breakpoints (char *, int);
164
165 static int hw_breakpoint_used_count (void);
166
167 static int hw_watchpoint_used_count (enum bptype, int *);
168
169 static void hbreak_command (char *, int);
170
171 static void thbreak_command (char *, int);
172
173 static void do_enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *, enum bpdisp);
174
175 static void stop_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
176
177 static void stopin_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
178
179 static void stopat_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
180
181 static char *ep_parse_optional_if_clause (char **arg);
182
183 static void catch_exception_command_1 (enum exception_event_kind ex_event,
184 char *arg, int tempflag, int from_tty);
185
186 static void tcatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
187
188 static void detach_single_step_breakpoints (void);
189
190 static int single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *,
191 CORE_ADDR pc);
192
193 static void free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc);
194 static void incref_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc);
195 static void decref_bp_location (struct bp_location **loc);
196
197 static struct bp_location *allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt);
198
199 static void update_global_location_list (int);
200
201 static void update_global_location_list_nothrow (int);
202
203 static int is_hardware_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt);
204
205 static int is_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt);
206
207 static void insert_breakpoint_locations (void);
208
209 static int syscall_catchpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b);
210
211 static void tracepoints_info (char *, int);
212
213 static void delete_trace_command (char *, int);
214
215 static void enable_trace_command (char *, int);
216
217 static void disable_trace_command (char *, int);
218
219 static void trace_pass_command (char *, int);
220
221 /* Assuming we're creating a static tracepoint, does S look like a
222 static tracepoint marker spec ("-m MARKER_ID")? */
223 #define is_marker_spec(s) \
224 (s != NULL && strncmp (s, "-m", 2) == 0 && ((s)[2] == ' ' || (s)[2] == '\t'))
225
226 /* A reference-counted struct command_line. This lets multiple
227 breakpoints share a single command list. */
228 struct counted_command_line
229 {
230 /* The reference count. */
231 int refc;
232
233 /* The command list. */
234 struct command_line *commands;
235 };
236
237 struct command_line *
238 breakpoint_commands (struct breakpoint *b)
239 {
240 return b->commands ? b->commands->commands : NULL;
241 }
242
243 /* Flag indicating that a command has proceeded the inferior past the
244 current breakpoint. */
245
246 static int breakpoint_proceeded;
247
248 static const char *
249 bpdisp_text (enum bpdisp disp)
250 {
251 /* NOTE: the following values are a part of MI protocol and
252 represent values of 'disp' field returned when inferior stops at
253 a breakpoint. */
254 static const char * const bpdisps[] = {"del", "dstp", "dis", "keep"};
255
256 return bpdisps[(int) disp];
257 }
258
259 /* Prototypes for exported functions. */
260 /* If FALSE, gdb will not use hardware support for watchpoints, even
261 if such is available. */
262 static int can_use_hw_watchpoints;
263
264 static void
265 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
266 struct cmd_list_element *c,
267 const char *value)
268 {
269 fprintf_filtered (file,
270 _("Debugger's willingness to use "
271 "watchpoint hardware is %s.\n"),
272 value);
273 }
274
275 /* If AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE, gdb will not attempt to create pending breakpoints.
276 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE, gdb will automatically create pending breakpoints
277 for unrecognized breakpoint locations.
278 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO, gdb will query when breakpoints are unrecognized. */
279 static enum auto_boolean pending_break_support;
280 static void
281 show_pending_break_support (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
282 struct cmd_list_element *c,
283 const char *value)
284 {
285 fprintf_filtered (file,
286 _("Debugger's behavior regarding "
287 "pending breakpoints is %s.\n"),
288 value);
289 }
290
291 /* If 1, gdb will automatically use hardware breakpoints for breakpoints
292 set with "break" but falling in read-only memory.
293 If 0, gdb will warn about such breakpoints, but won't automatically
294 use hardware breakpoints. */
295 static int automatic_hardware_breakpoints;
296 static void
297 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
298 struct cmd_list_element *c,
299 const char *value)
300 {
301 fprintf_filtered (file,
302 _("Automatic usage of hardware breakpoints is %s.\n"),
303 value);
304 }
305
306 /* If on, gdb will keep breakpoints inserted even as inferior is
307 stopped, and immediately insert any new breakpoints. If off, gdb
308 will insert breakpoints into inferior only when resuming it, and
309 will remove breakpoints upon stop. If auto, GDB will behave as ON
310 if in non-stop mode, and as OFF if all-stop mode.*/
311
312 static const char always_inserted_auto[] = "auto";
313 static const char always_inserted_on[] = "on";
314 static const char always_inserted_off[] = "off";
315 static const char *always_inserted_enums[] = {
316 always_inserted_auto,
317 always_inserted_off,
318 always_inserted_on,
319 NULL
320 };
321 static const char *always_inserted_mode = always_inserted_auto;
322 static void
323 show_always_inserted_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
324 struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
325 {
326 if (always_inserted_mode == always_inserted_auto)
327 fprintf_filtered (file,
328 _("Always inserted breakpoint "
329 "mode is %s (currently %s).\n"),
330 value,
331 breakpoints_always_inserted_mode () ? "on" : "off");
332 else
333 fprintf_filtered (file, _("Always inserted breakpoint mode is %s.\n"),
334 value);
335 }
336
337 int
338 breakpoints_always_inserted_mode (void)
339 {
340 return (always_inserted_mode == always_inserted_on
341 || (always_inserted_mode == always_inserted_auto && non_stop));
342 }
343
344 void _initialize_breakpoint (void);
345
346 /* Are we executing breakpoint commands? */
347 static int executing_breakpoint_commands;
348
349 /* Are overlay event breakpoints enabled? */
350 static int overlay_events_enabled;
351
352 /* See description in breakpoint.h. */
353 int target_exact_watchpoints = 0;
354
355 /* Walk the following statement or block through all breakpoints.
356 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE does so even if the statment deletes the
357 current breakpoint. */
358
359 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS(B) for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next)
360
361 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE(B,TMP) \
362 for (B = breakpoint_chain; \
363 B ? (TMP=B->next, 1): 0; \
364 B = TMP)
365
366 /* Similar iterator for the low-level breakpoints. SAFE variant is
367 not provided so update_global_location_list must not be called
368 while executing the block of ALL_BP_LOCATIONS. */
369
370 #define ALL_BP_LOCATIONS(B,BP_TMP) \
371 for (BP_TMP = bp_location; \
372 BP_TMP < bp_location + bp_location_count && (B = *BP_TMP); \
373 BP_TMP++)
374
375 /* Iterator for tracepoints only. */
376
377 #define ALL_TRACEPOINTS(B) \
378 for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next) \
379 if (is_tracepoint (B))
380
381 /* Chains of all breakpoints defined. */
382
383 struct breakpoint *breakpoint_chain;
384
385 /* Array is sorted by bp_location_compare - primarily by the ADDRESS. */
386
387 static struct bp_location **bp_location;
388
389 /* Number of elements of BP_LOCATION. */
390
391 static unsigned bp_location_count;
392
393 /* Maximum alignment offset between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS and
394 ADDRESS for the current elements of BP_LOCATION which get a valid
395 result from bp_location_has_shadow. You can use it for roughly
396 limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATION to scan for shadow bytes for
397 an address you need to read. */
398
399 static CORE_ADDR bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max;
400
401 /* Maximum offset plus alignment between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS
402 + bp_target_info.SHADOW_LEN and ADDRESS for the current elements of
403 BP_LOCATION which get a valid result from bp_location_has_shadow.
404 You can use it for roughly limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATION to
405 scan for shadow bytes for an address you need to read. */
406
407 static CORE_ADDR bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max;
408
409 /* The locations that no longer correspond to any breakpoint, unlinked
410 from bp_location array, but for which a hit may still be reported
411 by a target. */
412 VEC(bp_location_p) *moribund_locations = NULL;
413
414 /* Number of last breakpoint made. */
415
416 static int breakpoint_count;
417
418 /* The value of `breakpoint_count' before the last command that
419 created breakpoints. If the last (break-like) command created more
420 than one breakpoint, then the difference between BREAKPOINT_COUNT
421 and PREV_BREAKPOINT_COUNT is more than one. */
422 static int prev_breakpoint_count;
423
424 /* Number of last tracepoint made. */
425
426 static int tracepoint_count;
427
428 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_set_cmdlist;
429 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_show_cmdlist;
430 struct cmd_list_element *save_cmdlist;
431
432 /* Return whether a breakpoint is an active enabled breakpoint. */
433 static int
434 breakpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *b)
435 {
436 return (b->enable_state == bp_enabled);
437 }
438
439 /* Set breakpoint count to NUM. */
440
441 static void
442 set_breakpoint_count (int num)
443 {
444 prev_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count;
445 breakpoint_count = num;
446 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("bpnum"), num);
447 }
448
449 /* Used by `start_rbreak_breakpoints' below, to record the current
450 breakpoint count before "rbreak" creates any breakpoint. */
451 static int rbreak_start_breakpoint_count;
452
453 /* Called at the start an "rbreak" command to record the first
454 breakpoint made. */
455
456 void
457 start_rbreak_breakpoints (void)
458 {
459 rbreak_start_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count;
460 }
461
462 /* Called at the end of an "rbreak" command to record the last
463 breakpoint made. */
464
465 void
466 end_rbreak_breakpoints (void)
467 {
468 prev_breakpoint_count = rbreak_start_breakpoint_count;
469 }
470
471 /* Used in run_command to zero the hit count when a new run starts. */
472
473 void
474 clear_breakpoint_hit_counts (void)
475 {
476 struct breakpoint *b;
477
478 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
479 b->hit_count = 0;
480 }
481
482 /* Allocate a new counted_command_line with reference count of 1.
483 The new structure owns COMMANDS. */
484
485 static struct counted_command_line *
486 alloc_counted_command_line (struct command_line *commands)
487 {
488 struct counted_command_line *result
489 = xmalloc (sizeof (struct counted_command_line));
490
491 result->refc = 1;
492 result->commands = commands;
493 return result;
494 }
495
496 /* Increment reference count. This does nothing if CMD is NULL. */
497
498 static void
499 incref_counted_command_line (struct counted_command_line *cmd)
500 {
501 if (cmd)
502 ++cmd->refc;
503 }
504
505 /* Decrement reference count. If the reference count reaches 0,
506 destroy the counted_command_line. Sets *CMDP to NULL. This does
507 nothing if *CMDP is NULL. */
508
509 static void
510 decref_counted_command_line (struct counted_command_line **cmdp)
511 {
512 if (*cmdp)
513 {
514 if (--(*cmdp)->refc == 0)
515 {
516 free_command_lines (&(*cmdp)->commands);
517 xfree (*cmdp);
518 }
519 *cmdp = NULL;
520 }
521 }
522
523 /* A cleanup function that calls decref_counted_command_line. */
524
525 static void
526 do_cleanup_counted_command_line (void *arg)
527 {
528 decref_counted_command_line (arg);
529 }
530
531 /* Create a cleanup that calls decref_counted_command_line on the
532 argument. */
533
534 static struct cleanup *
535 make_cleanup_decref_counted_command_line (struct counted_command_line **cmdp)
536 {
537 return make_cleanup (do_cleanup_counted_command_line, cmdp);
538 }
539
540 /* Default address, symtab and line to put a breakpoint at
541 for "break" command with no arg.
542 If default_breakpoint_valid is zero, the other three are
543 not valid, and "break" with no arg is an error.
544
545 This set by print_stack_frame, which calls set_default_breakpoint. */
546
547 int default_breakpoint_valid;
548 CORE_ADDR default_breakpoint_address;
549 struct symtab *default_breakpoint_symtab;
550 int default_breakpoint_line;
551 struct program_space *default_breakpoint_pspace;
552
553 \f
554 /* Return the breakpoint with the specified number, or NULL
555 if the number does not refer to an existing breakpoint. */
556
557 struct breakpoint *
558 get_breakpoint (int num)
559 {
560 struct breakpoint *b;
561
562 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
563 if (b->number == num)
564 return b;
565
566 return NULL;
567 }
568
569 \f
570
571 void
572 set_breakpoint_condition (struct breakpoint *b, char *exp,
573 int from_tty)
574 {
575 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
576
577 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
578 {
579 xfree (loc->cond);
580 loc->cond = NULL;
581 }
582 xfree (b->cond_string);
583 b->cond_string = NULL;
584 xfree (b->cond_exp);
585 b->cond_exp = NULL;
586
587 if (*exp == 0)
588 {
589 if (from_tty)
590 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint %d now unconditional.\n"), b->number);
591 }
592 else
593 {
594 char *arg = exp;
595
596 /* I don't know if it matters whether this is the string the user
597 typed in or the decompiled expression. */
598 b->cond_string = xstrdup (arg);
599 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
600
601 if (is_watchpoint (b))
602 {
603 innermost_block = NULL;
604 arg = exp;
605 b->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0);
606 if (*arg)
607 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
608 b->cond_exp_valid_block = innermost_block;
609 }
610 else
611 {
612 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
613 {
614 arg = exp;
615 loc->cond =
616 parse_exp_1 (&arg, block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
617 if (*arg)
618 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
619 }
620 }
621 }
622 breakpoints_changed ();
623 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
624 }
625
626 /* condition N EXP -- set break condition of breakpoint N to EXP. */
627
628 static void
629 condition_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
630 {
631 struct breakpoint *b;
632 char *p;
633 int bnum;
634
635 if (arg == 0)
636 error_no_arg (_("breakpoint number"));
637
638 p = arg;
639 bnum = get_number (&p);
640 if (bnum == 0)
641 error (_("Bad breakpoint argument: '%s'"), arg);
642
643 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
644 if (b->number == bnum)
645 {
646 set_breakpoint_condition (b, p, from_tty);
647 return;
648 }
649
650 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum);
651 }
652
653 /* Check that COMMAND do not contain commands that are suitable
654 only for tracepoints and not suitable for ordinary breakpoints.
655 Throw if any such commands is found. */
656
657 static void
658 check_no_tracepoint_commands (struct command_line *commands)
659 {
660 struct command_line *c;
661
662 for (c = commands; c; c = c->next)
663 {
664 int i;
665
666 if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control)
667 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command can "
668 "only be used for tracepoints"));
669
670 for (i = 0; i < c->body_count; ++i)
671 check_no_tracepoint_commands ((c->body_list)[i]);
672
673 /* Not that command parsing removes leading whitespace and comment
674 lines and also empty lines. So, we only need to check for
675 command directly. */
676 if (strstr (c->line, "collect ") == c->line)
677 error (_("The 'collect' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
678
679 if (strstr (c->line, "teval ") == c->line)
680 error (_("The 'teval' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
681 }
682 }
683
684 /* Encapsulate tests for different types of tracepoints. */
685
686 int
687 is_tracepoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
688 {
689 return (b->type == bp_tracepoint
690 || b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint
691 || b->type == bp_static_tracepoint);
692 }
693
694 /* A helper function that validsates that COMMANDS are valid for a
695 breakpoint. This function will throw an exception if a problem is
696 found. */
697
698 static void
699 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
700 struct command_line *commands)
701 {
702 if (is_tracepoint (b))
703 {
704 /* We need to verify that each top-level element of commands is
705 valid for tracepoints, that there's at most one
706 while-stepping element, and that while-stepping's body has
707 valid tracing commands excluding nested while-stepping. */
708 struct command_line *c;
709 struct command_line *while_stepping = 0;
710 for (c = commands; c; c = c->next)
711 {
712 if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control)
713 {
714 if (b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint)
715 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
716 "cannot be used for fast tracepoint"));
717 else if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
718 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
719 "cannot be used for static tracepoint"));
720
721 if (while_stepping)
722 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
723 "can be used only once"));
724 else
725 while_stepping = c;
726 }
727 }
728 if (while_stepping)
729 {
730 struct command_line *c2;
731
732 gdb_assert (while_stepping->body_count == 1);
733 c2 = while_stepping->body_list[0];
734 for (; c2; c2 = c2->next)
735 {
736 if (c2->control_type == while_stepping_control)
737 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command cannot be nested"));
738 }
739 }
740 }
741 else
742 {
743 check_no_tracepoint_commands (commands);
744 }
745 }
746
747 /* Return a vector of all the static tracepoints set at ADDR. The
748 caller is responsible for releasing the vector. */
749
750 VEC(breakpoint_p) *
751 static_tracepoints_here (CORE_ADDR addr)
752 {
753 struct breakpoint *b;
754 VEC(breakpoint_p) *found = 0;
755 struct bp_location *loc;
756
757 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
758 if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
759 {
760 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
761 if (loc->address == addr)
762 VEC_safe_push(breakpoint_p, found, b);
763 }
764
765 return found;
766 }
767
768 /* Set the command list of B to COMMANDS. If breakpoint is tracepoint,
769 validate that only allowed commands are included. */
770
771 void
772 breakpoint_set_commands (struct breakpoint *b,
773 struct command_line *commands)
774 {
775 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, commands);
776
777 decref_counted_command_line (&b->commands);
778 b->commands = alloc_counted_command_line (commands);
779 breakpoints_changed ();
780 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
781 }
782
783 /* Set the internal `silent' flag on the breakpoint. Note that this
784 is not the same as the "silent" that may appear in the breakpoint's
785 commands. */
786
787 void
788 breakpoint_set_silent (struct breakpoint *b, int silent)
789 {
790 int old_silent = b->silent;
791
792 b->silent = silent;
793 if (old_silent != silent)
794 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
795 }
796
797 /* Set the thread for this breakpoint. If THREAD is -1, make the
798 breakpoint work for any thread. */
799
800 void
801 breakpoint_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b, int thread)
802 {
803 int old_thread = b->thread;
804
805 b->thread = thread;
806 if (old_thread != thread)
807 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
808 }
809
810 /* Set the task for this breakpoint. If TASK is 0, make the
811 breakpoint work for any task. */
812
813 void
814 breakpoint_set_task (struct breakpoint *b, int task)
815 {
816 int old_task = b->task;
817
818 b->task = task;
819 if (old_task != task)
820 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
821 }
822
823 void
824 check_tracepoint_command (char *line, void *closure)
825 {
826 struct breakpoint *b = closure;
827
828 validate_actionline (&line, b);
829 }
830
831 /* A structure used to pass information through
832 map_breakpoint_numbers. */
833
834 struct commands_info
835 {
836 /* True if the command was typed at a tty. */
837 int from_tty;
838
839 /* The breakpoint range spec. */
840 char *arg;
841
842 /* Non-NULL if the body of the commands are being read from this
843 already-parsed command. */
844 struct command_line *control;
845
846 /* The command lines read from the user, or NULL if they have not
847 yet been read. */
848 struct counted_command_line *cmd;
849 };
850
851 /* A callback for map_breakpoint_numbers that sets the commands for
852 commands_command. */
853
854 static void
855 do_map_commands_command (struct breakpoint *b, void *data)
856 {
857 struct commands_info *info = data;
858
859 if (info->cmd == NULL)
860 {
861 struct command_line *l;
862
863 if (info->control != NULL)
864 l = copy_command_lines (info->control->body_list[0]);
865 else
866 {
867 struct cleanup *old_chain;
868 char *str;
869
870 str = xstrprintf (_("Type commands for breakpoint(s) "
871 "%s, one per line."),
872 info->arg);
873
874 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, str);
875
876 l = read_command_lines (str,
877 info->from_tty, 1,
878 (is_tracepoint (b)
879 ? check_tracepoint_command : 0),
880 b);
881
882 do_cleanups (old_chain);
883 }
884
885 info->cmd = alloc_counted_command_line (l);
886 }
887
888 /* If a breakpoint was on the list more than once, we don't need to
889 do anything. */
890 if (b->commands != info->cmd)
891 {
892 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, info->cmd->commands);
893 incref_counted_command_line (info->cmd);
894 decref_counted_command_line (&b->commands);
895 b->commands = info->cmd;
896 breakpoints_changed ();
897 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
898 }
899 }
900
901 static void
902 commands_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty,
903 struct command_line *control)
904 {
905 struct cleanup *cleanups;
906 struct commands_info info;
907
908 info.from_tty = from_tty;
909 info.control = control;
910 info.cmd = NULL;
911 /* If we read command lines from the user, then `info' will hold an
912 extra reference to the commands that we must clean up. */
913 cleanups = make_cleanup_decref_counted_command_line (&info.cmd);
914
915 if (arg == NULL || !*arg)
916 {
917 if (breakpoint_count - prev_breakpoint_count > 1)
918 arg = xstrprintf ("%d-%d", prev_breakpoint_count + 1,
919 breakpoint_count);
920 else if (breakpoint_count > 0)
921 arg = xstrprintf ("%d", breakpoint_count);
922 else
923 {
924 /* So that we don't try to free the incoming non-NULL
925 argument in the cleanup below. Mapping breakpoint
926 numbers will fail in this case. */
927 arg = NULL;
928 }
929 }
930 else
931 /* The command loop has some static state, so we need to preserve
932 our argument. */
933 arg = xstrdup (arg);
934
935 if (arg != NULL)
936 make_cleanup (xfree, arg);
937
938 info.arg = arg;
939
940 map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, do_map_commands_command, &info);
941
942 if (info.cmd == NULL)
943 error (_("No breakpoints specified."));
944
945 do_cleanups (cleanups);
946 }
947
948 static void
949 commands_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
950 {
951 commands_command_1 (arg, from_tty, NULL);
952 }
953
954 /* Like commands_command, but instead of reading the commands from
955 input stream, takes them from an already parsed command structure.
956
957 This is used by cli-script.c to DTRT with breakpoint commands
958 that are part of if and while bodies. */
959 enum command_control_type
960 commands_from_control_command (char *arg, struct command_line *cmd)
961 {
962 commands_command_1 (arg, 0, cmd);
963 return simple_control;
964 }
965
966 /* Return non-zero if BL->TARGET_INFO contains valid information. */
967
968 static int
969 bp_location_has_shadow (struct bp_location *bl)
970 {
971 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
972 return 0;
973 if (!bl->inserted)
974 return 0;
975 if (bl->target_info.shadow_len == 0)
976 /* bp isn't valid, or doesn't shadow memory. */
977 return 0;
978 return 1;
979 }
980
981 /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address MEMADDR,
982 by replacing any memory breakpoints with their shadowed contents.
983
984 The range of shadowed area by each bp_location is:
985 bl->address - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
986 up to bl->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max
987 The range we were requested to resolve shadows for is:
988 memaddr ... memaddr + len
989 Thus the safe cutoff boundaries for performance optimization are
990 memaddr + len <= (bl->address
991 - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max)
992 and:
993 bl->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max <= memaddr */
994
995 void
996 breakpoint_restore_shadows (gdb_byte *buf, ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len)
997 {
998 /* Left boundary, right boundary and median element of our binary
999 search. */
1000 unsigned bc_l, bc_r, bc;
1001
1002 /* Find BC_L which is a leftmost element which may affect BUF
1003 content. It is safe to report lower value but a failure to
1004 report higher one. */
1005
1006 bc_l = 0;
1007 bc_r = bp_location_count;
1008 while (bc_l + 1 < bc_r)
1009 {
1010 struct bp_location *bl;
1011
1012 bc = (bc_l + bc_r) / 2;
1013 bl = bp_location[bc];
1014
1015 /* Check first BL->ADDRESS will not overflow due to the added
1016 constant. Then advance the left boundary only if we are sure
1017 the BC element can in no way affect the BUF content (MEMADDR
1018 to MEMADDR + LEN range).
1019
1020 Use the BP_LOCATION_SHADOW_LEN_AFTER_ADDRESS_MAX safety
1021 offset so that we cannot miss a breakpoint with its shadow
1022 range tail still reaching MEMADDR. */
1023
1024 if ((bl->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max
1025 >= bl->address)
1026 && (bl->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max
1027 <= memaddr))
1028 bc_l = bc;
1029 else
1030 bc_r = bc;
1031 }
1032
1033 /* Due to the binary search above, we need to make sure we pick the
1034 first location that's at BC_L's address. E.g., if there are
1035 multiple locations at the same address, BC_L may end up pointing
1036 at a duplicate location, and miss the "master"/"inserted"
1037 location. Say, given locations L1, L2 and L3 at addresses A and
1038 B:
1039
1040 L1@A, L2@A, L3@B, ...
1041
1042 BC_L could end up pointing at location L2, while the "master"
1043 location could be L1. Since the `loc->inserted' flag is only set
1044 on "master" locations, we'd forget to restore the shadow of L1
1045 and L2. */
1046 while (bc_l > 0
1047 && bp_location[bc_l]->address == bp_location[bc_l - 1]->address)
1048 bc_l--;
1049
1050 /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
1051
1052 for (bc = bc_l; bc < bp_location_count; bc++)
1053 {
1054 struct bp_location *bl = bp_location[bc];
1055 CORE_ADDR bp_addr = 0;
1056 int bp_size = 0;
1057 int bptoffset = 0;
1058
1059 /* bp_location array has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
1060 if (bl->owner->type == bp_none)
1061 warning (_("reading through apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
1062 bl->owner->number);
1063
1064 /* Performance optimization: any futher element can no longer affect BUF
1065 content. */
1066
1067 if (bl->address >= bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
1068 && memaddr + len <= (bl->address
1069 - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max))
1070 break;
1071
1072 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
1073 continue;
1074 if (!breakpoint_address_match (bl->target_info.placed_address_space, 0,
1075 current_program_space->aspace, 0))
1076 continue;
1077
1078 /* Addresses and length of the part of the breakpoint that
1079 we need to copy. */
1080 bp_addr = bl->target_info.placed_address;
1081 bp_size = bl->target_info.shadow_len;
1082
1083 if (bp_addr + bp_size <= memaddr)
1084 /* The breakpoint is entirely before the chunk of memory we
1085 are reading. */
1086 continue;
1087
1088 if (bp_addr >= memaddr + len)
1089 /* The breakpoint is entirely after the chunk of memory we are
1090 reading. */
1091 continue;
1092
1093 /* Offset within shadow_contents. */
1094 if (bp_addr < memaddr)
1095 {
1096 /* Only copy the second part of the breakpoint. */
1097 bp_size -= memaddr - bp_addr;
1098 bptoffset = memaddr - bp_addr;
1099 bp_addr = memaddr;
1100 }
1101
1102 if (bp_addr + bp_size > memaddr + len)
1103 {
1104 /* Only copy the first part of the breakpoint. */
1105 bp_size -= (bp_addr + bp_size) - (memaddr + len);
1106 }
1107
1108 memcpy (buf + bp_addr - memaddr,
1109 bl->target_info.shadow_contents + bptoffset, bp_size);
1110 }
1111 }
1112 \f
1113
1114 /* Return true if BPT is of any hardware watchpoint kind. */
1115
1116 static int
1117 is_hardware_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1118 {
1119 return (bpt->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
1120 || bpt->type == bp_read_watchpoint
1121 || bpt->type == bp_access_watchpoint);
1122 }
1123
1124 /* Return true if BPT is of any watchpoint kind, hardware or
1125 software. */
1126
1127 static int
1128 is_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1129 {
1130 return (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt)
1131 || bpt->type == bp_watchpoint);
1132 }
1133
1134 /* Assuming that B is a watchpoint: returns true if the current thread
1135 and its running state are safe to evaluate or update watchpoint B.
1136 Watchpoints on local expressions need to be evaluated in the
1137 context of the thread that was current when the watchpoint was
1138 created, and, that thread needs to be stopped to be able to select
1139 the correct frame context. Watchpoints on global expressions can
1140 be evaluated on any thread, and in any state. It is presently left
1141 to the target allowing memory accesses when threads are
1142 running. */
1143
1144 static int
1145 watchpoint_in_thread_scope (struct breakpoint *b)
1146 {
1147 return (ptid_equal (b->watchpoint_thread, null_ptid)
1148 || (ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, b->watchpoint_thread)
1149 && !is_executing (inferior_ptid)));
1150 }
1151
1152 /* Assuming that B is a watchpoint:
1153 - Reparse watchpoint expression, if REPARSE is non-zero
1154 - Evaluate expression and store the result in B->val
1155 - Evaluate the condition if there is one, and store the result
1156 in b->loc->cond.
1157 - Update the list of values that must be watched in B->loc.
1158
1159 If the watchpoint disposition is disp_del_at_next_stop, then do
1160 nothing. If this is local watchpoint that is out of scope, delete
1161 it.
1162
1163 Even with `set breakpoint always-inserted on' the watchpoints are
1164 removed + inserted on each stop here. Normal breakpoints must
1165 never be removed because they might be missed by a running thread
1166 when debugging in non-stop mode. On the other hand, hardware
1167 watchpoints (is_hardware_watchpoint; processed here) are specific
1168 to each LWP since they are stored in each LWP's hardware debug
1169 registers. Therefore, such LWP must be stopped first in order to
1170 be able to modify its hardware watchpoints.
1171
1172 Hardware watchpoints must be reset exactly once after being
1173 presented to the user. It cannot be done sooner, because it would
1174 reset the data used to present the watchpoint hit to the user. And
1175 it must not be done later because it could display the same single
1176 watchpoint hit during multiple GDB stops. Note that the latter is
1177 relevant only to the hardware watchpoint types bp_read_watchpoint
1178 and bp_access_watchpoint. False hit by bp_hardware_watchpoint is
1179 not user-visible - its hit is suppressed if the memory content has
1180 not changed.
1181
1182 The following constraints influence the location where we can reset
1183 hardware watchpoints:
1184
1185 * target_stopped_by_watchpoint and target_stopped_data_address are
1186 called several times when GDB stops.
1187
1188 [linux]
1189 * Multiple hardware watchpoints can be hit at the same time,
1190 causing GDB to stop. GDB only presents one hardware watchpoint
1191 hit at a time as the reason for stopping, and all the other hits
1192 are presented later, one after the other, each time the user
1193 requests the execution to be resumed. Execution is not resumed
1194 for the threads still having pending hit event stored in
1195 LWP_INFO->STATUS. While the watchpoint is already removed from
1196 the inferior on the first stop the thread hit event is kept being
1197 reported from its cached value by linux_nat_stopped_data_address
1198 until the real thread resume happens after the watchpoint gets
1199 presented and thus its LWP_INFO->STATUS gets reset.
1200
1201 Therefore the hardware watchpoint hit can get safely reset on the
1202 watchpoint removal from inferior. */
1203
1204 static void
1205 update_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, int reparse)
1206 {
1207 int within_current_scope;
1208 struct frame_id saved_frame_id;
1209 int frame_saved;
1210
1211 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
1212 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
1213 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
1214 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
1215 return;
1216
1217 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1218 return;
1219
1220 frame_saved = 0;
1221
1222 /* Determine if the watchpoint is within scope. */
1223 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
1224 within_current_scope = 1;
1225 else
1226 {
1227 struct frame_info *fi = get_current_frame ();
1228 struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (fi);
1229 CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (fi);
1230
1231 /* If we're in a function epilogue, unwinding may not work
1232 properly, so do not attempt to recreate locations at this
1233 point. See similar comments in watchpoint_check. */
1234 if (gdbarch_in_function_epilogue_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
1235 return;
1236
1237 /* Save the current frame's ID so we can restore it after
1238 evaluating the watchpoint expression on its own frame. */
1239 /* FIXME drow/2003-09-09: It would be nice if evaluate_expression
1240 took a frame parameter, so that we didn't have to change the
1241 selected frame. */
1242 frame_saved = 1;
1243 saved_frame_id = get_frame_id (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1244
1245 fi = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
1246 within_current_scope = (fi != NULL);
1247 if (within_current_scope)
1248 select_frame (fi);
1249 }
1250
1251 /* We don't free locations. They are stored in the bp_location array
1252 and update_global_location_list will eventually delete them and
1253 remove breakpoints if needed. */
1254 b->loc = NULL;
1255
1256 if (within_current_scope && reparse)
1257 {
1258 char *s;
1259
1260 if (b->exp)
1261 {
1262 xfree (b->exp);
1263 b->exp = NULL;
1264 }
1265 s = b->exp_string_reparse ? b->exp_string_reparse : b->exp_string;
1266 b->exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, b->exp_valid_block, 0);
1267 /* If the meaning of expression itself changed, the old value is
1268 no longer relevant. We don't want to report a watchpoint hit
1269 to the user when the old value and the new value may actually
1270 be completely different objects. */
1271 value_free (b->val);
1272 b->val = NULL;
1273 b->val_valid = 0;
1274
1275 /* Note that unlike with breakpoints, the watchpoint's condition
1276 expression is stored in the breakpoint object, not in the
1277 locations (re)created below. */
1278 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
1279 {
1280 if (b->cond_exp != NULL)
1281 {
1282 xfree (b->cond_exp);
1283 b->cond_exp = NULL;
1284 }
1285
1286 s = b->cond_string;
1287 b->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, b->cond_exp_valid_block, 0);
1288 }
1289 }
1290
1291 /* If we failed to parse the expression, for example because
1292 it refers to a global variable in a not-yet-loaded shared library,
1293 don't try to insert watchpoint. We don't automatically delete
1294 such watchpoint, though, since failure to parse expression
1295 is different from out-of-scope watchpoint. */
1296 if ( !target_has_execution)
1297 {
1298 /* Without execution, memory can't change. No use to try and
1299 set watchpoint locations. The watchpoint will be reset when
1300 the target gains execution, through breakpoint_re_set. */
1301 }
1302 else if (within_current_scope && b->exp)
1303 {
1304 int pc = 0;
1305 struct value *val_chain, *v, *result, *next;
1306 struct program_space *frame_pspace;
1307
1308 fetch_subexp_value (b->exp, &pc, &v, &result, &val_chain);
1309
1310 /* Avoid setting b->val if it's already set. The meaning of
1311 b->val is 'the last value' user saw, and we should update
1312 it only if we reported that last value to user. As it
1313 happens, the code that reports it updates b->val directly. */
1314 if (!b->val_valid)
1315 {
1316 b->val = v;
1317 b->val_valid = 1;
1318 }
1319
1320 frame_pspace = get_frame_program_space (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1321
1322 /* Look at each value on the value chain. */
1323 for (v = val_chain; v; v = value_next (v))
1324 {
1325 /* If it's a memory location, and GDB actually needed
1326 its contents to evaluate the expression, then we
1327 must watch it. If the first value returned is
1328 still lazy, that means an error occurred reading it;
1329 watch it anyway in case it becomes readable. */
1330 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory
1331 && (v == val_chain || ! value_lazy (v)))
1332 {
1333 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
1334
1335 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked
1336 for it explicitly, never if they just happen to
1337 appear in the middle of some value chain. */
1338 if (v == result
1339 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1340 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
1341 {
1342 CORE_ADDR addr;
1343 int len, type;
1344 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
1345
1346 addr = value_address (v);
1347 len = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
1348 type = hw_write;
1349 if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
1350 type = hw_read;
1351 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
1352 type = hw_access;
1353
1354 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
1355 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL; tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
1356 ;
1357 *tmp = loc;
1358 loc->gdbarch = get_type_arch (value_type (v));
1359
1360 loc->pspace = frame_pspace;
1361 loc->address = addr;
1362 loc->length = len;
1363 loc->watchpoint_type = type;
1364 }
1365 }
1366 }
1367
1368 /* Change the type of breakpoint between hardware assisted or
1369 an ordinary watchpoint depending on the hardware support
1370 and free hardware slots. REPARSE is set when the inferior
1371 is started. */
1372 if ((b->type == bp_watchpoint || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
1373 && reparse)
1374 {
1375 int reg_cnt;
1376 enum bp_loc_type loc_type;
1377 struct bp_location *bl;
1378
1379 reg_cnt = can_use_hardware_watchpoint (val_chain, b->exact);
1380
1381 if (reg_cnt)
1382 {
1383 int i, target_resources_ok, other_type_used;
1384 enum enable_state orig_enable_state;
1385
1386 /* We need to determine how many resources are already
1387 used for all other hardware watchpoints plus this one
1388 to see if we still have enough resources to also fit
1389 this watchpoint in as well. To guarantee the
1390 hw_watchpoint_used_count call below counts this
1391 watchpoint, make sure that it is marked as a hardware
1392 watchpoint. */
1393 b->type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
1394
1395 /* hw_watchpoint_used_count ignores disabled watchpoints,
1396 and b might be disabled if we're being called from
1397 do_enable_breakpoint. */
1398 orig_enable_state = b->enable_state;
1399 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
1400
1401 i = hw_watchpoint_used_count (bp_hardware_watchpoint,
1402 &other_type_used);
1403
1404 b->enable_state = orig_enable_state;
1405
1406 target_resources_ok = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint
1407 (bp_hardware_watchpoint, i, other_type_used);
1408 if (target_resources_ok <= 0)
1409 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1410 }
1411 else
1412 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1413
1414 loc_type = (b->type == bp_watchpoint? bp_loc_other
1415 : bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint);
1416 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
1417 bl->loc_type = loc_type;
1418 }
1419
1420 for (v = val_chain; v; v = next)
1421 {
1422 next = value_next (v);
1423 if (v != b->val)
1424 value_free (v);
1425 }
1426
1427 /* If a software watchpoint is not watching any memory, then the
1428 above left it without any location set up. But,
1429 bpstat_stop_status requires a location to be able to report
1430 stops, so make sure there's at least a dummy one. */
1431 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc == NULL)
1432 {
1433 b->loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
1434 b->loc->pspace = frame_pspace;
1435 b->loc->address = -1;
1436 b->loc->length = -1;
1437 b->loc->watchpoint_type = -1;
1438 }
1439 }
1440 else if (!within_current_scope)
1441 {
1442 printf_filtered (_("\
1443 Watchpoint %d deleted because the program has left the block\n\
1444 in which its expression is valid.\n"),
1445 b->number);
1446 if (b->related_breakpoint)
1447 {
1448 b->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1449 b->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = NULL;
1450 b->related_breakpoint= NULL;
1451 }
1452 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1453 }
1454
1455 /* Restore the selected frame. */
1456 if (frame_saved)
1457 select_frame (frame_find_by_id (saved_frame_id));
1458 }
1459
1460
1461 /* Returns 1 iff breakpoint location should be
1462 inserted in the inferior. */
1463 static int
1464 should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bl)
1465 {
1466 if (bl->owner == NULL || !breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner))
1467 return 0;
1468
1469 if (bl->owner->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1470 return 0;
1471
1472 if (!bl->enabled || bl->shlib_disabled || bl->duplicate)
1473 return 0;
1474
1475 /* This is set for example, when we're attached to the parent of a
1476 vfork, and have detached from the child. The child is running
1477 free, and we expect it to do an exec or exit, at which point the
1478 OS makes the parent schedulable again (and the target reports
1479 that the vfork is done). Until the child is done with the shared
1480 memory region, do not insert breakpoints in the parent, otherwise
1481 the child could still trip on the parent's breakpoints. Since
1482 the parent is blocked anyway, it won't miss any breakpoint. */
1483 if (bl->pspace->breakpoints_not_allowed)
1484 return 0;
1485
1486 /* Tracepoints are inserted by the target at a time of its choosing,
1487 not by us. */
1488 if (is_tracepoint (bl->owner))
1489 return 0;
1490
1491 return 1;
1492 }
1493
1494 /* Insert a low-level "breakpoint" of some type. BL is the breakpoint
1495 location. Any error messages are printed to TMP_ERROR_STREAM; and
1496 DISABLED_BREAKS, and HW_BREAKPOINT_ERROR are used to report problems.
1497
1498 NOTE drow/2003-09-09: This routine could be broken down to an
1499 object-style method for each breakpoint or catchpoint type. */
1500 static int
1501 insert_bp_location (struct bp_location *bl,
1502 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream,
1503 int *disabled_breaks,
1504 int *hw_breakpoint_error)
1505 {
1506 int val = 0;
1507
1508 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || bl->inserted)
1509 return 0;
1510
1511 /* Initialize the target-specific information. */
1512 memset (&bl->target_info, 0, sizeof (bl->target_info));
1513 bl->target_info.placed_address = bl->address;
1514 bl->target_info.placed_address_space = bl->pspace->aspace;
1515
1516 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
1517 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1518 {
1519 if (bl->owner->type != bp_hardware_breakpoint)
1520 {
1521 /* If the explicitly specified breakpoint type
1522 is not hardware breakpoint, check the memory map to see
1523 if the breakpoint address is in read only memory or not.
1524
1525 Two important cases are:
1526 - location type is not hardware breakpoint, memory
1527 is readonly. We change the type of the location to
1528 hardware breakpoint.
1529 - location type is hardware breakpoint, memory is
1530 read-write. This means we've previously made the
1531 location hardware one, but then the memory map changed,
1532 so we undo.
1533
1534 When breakpoints are removed, remove_breakpoints will use
1535 location types we've just set here, the only possible
1536 problem is that memory map has changed during running
1537 program, but it's not going to work anyway with current
1538 gdb. */
1539 struct mem_region *mr
1540 = lookup_mem_region (bl->target_info.placed_address);
1541
1542 if (mr)
1543 {
1544 if (automatic_hardware_breakpoints)
1545 {
1546 enum bp_loc_type new_type;
1547
1548 if (mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
1549 new_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
1550 else
1551 new_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
1552
1553 if (new_type != bl->loc_type)
1554 {
1555 static int said = 0;
1556
1557 bl->loc_type = new_type;
1558 if (!said)
1559 {
1560 fprintf_filtered (gdb_stdout,
1561 _("Note: automatically using "
1562 "hardware breakpoints for "
1563 "read-only addresses.\n"));
1564 said = 1;
1565 }
1566 }
1567 }
1568 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
1569 && mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
1570 warning (_("cannot set software breakpoint "
1571 "at readonly address %s"),
1572 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address));
1573 }
1574 }
1575
1576 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
1577 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
1578 || bl->section == NULL
1579 || !(section_is_overlay (bl->section)))
1580 {
1581 /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
1582
1583 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1584 val = target_insert_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
1585 &bl->target_info);
1586 else
1587 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
1588 &bl->target_info);
1589 }
1590 else
1591 {
1592 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
1593 Shall we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
1594 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
1595 {
1596 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active,
1597 so we must try to set a breakpoint at the LMA.
1598 This will not work for a hardware breakpoint. */
1599 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1600 warning (_("hardware breakpoint %d not supported in overlay!"),
1601 bl->owner->number);
1602 else
1603 {
1604 CORE_ADDR addr = overlay_unmapped_address (bl->address,
1605 bl->section);
1606 /* Set a software (trap) breakpoint at the LMA. */
1607 bl->overlay_target_info = bl->target_info;
1608 bl->overlay_target_info.placed_address = addr;
1609 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
1610 &bl->overlay_target_info);
1611 if (val != 0)
1612 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1613 "Overlay breakpoint %d "
1614 "failed: in ROM?\n",
1615 bl->owner->number);
1616 }
1617 }
1618 /* Shall we set a breakpoint at the VMA? */
1619 if (section_is_mapped (bl->section))
1620 {
1621 /* Yes. This overlay section is mapped into memory. */
1622 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1623 val = target_insert_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
1624 &bl->target_info);
1625 else
1626 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
1627 &bl->target_info);
1628 }
1629 else
1630 {
1631 /* No. This breakpoint will not be inserted.
1632 No error, but do not mark the bp as 'inserted'. */
1633 return 0;
1634 }
1635 }
1636
1637 if (val)
1638 {
1639 /* Can't set the breakpoint. */
1640 if (solib_name_from_address (bl->pspace, bl->address))
1641 {
1642 /* See also: disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs. */
1643 val = 0;
1644 bl->shlib_disabled = 1;
1645 if (!*disabled_breaks)
1646 {
1647 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1648 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n",
1649 bl->owner->number);
1650 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1651 "Temporarily disabling shared "
1652 "library breakpoints:\n");
1653 }
1654 *disabled_breaks = 1;
1655 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1656 "breakpoint #%d\n", bl->owner->number);
1657 }
1658 else
1659 {
1660 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1661 {
1662 *hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
1663 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1664 "Cannot insert hardware "
1665 "breakpoint %d.\n",
1666 bl->owner->number);
1667 }
1668 else
1669 {
1670 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1671 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n",
1672 bl->owner->number);
1673 fprintf_filtered (tmp_error_stream,
1674 "Error accessing memory address ");
1675 fputs_filtered (paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address),
1676 tmp_error_stream);
1677 fprintf_filtered (tmp_error_stream, ": %s.\n",
1678 safe_strerror (val));
1679 }
1680
1681 }
1682 }
1683 else
1684 bl->inserted = 1;
1685
1686 return val;
1687 }
1688
1689 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
1690 /* NOTE drow/2003-09-08: This state only exists for removing
1691 watchpoints. It's not clear that it's necessary... */
1692 && bl->owner->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
1693 {
1694 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
1695 && bl->owner->ops->insert_location != NULL);
1696
1697 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
1698
1699 /* If trying to set a read-watchpoint, and it turns out it's not
1700 supported, try emulating one with an access watchpoint. */
1701 if (val == 1 && bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
1702 {
1703 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
1704
1705 /* But don't try to insert it, if there's already another
1706 hw_access location that would be considered a duplicate
1707 of this one. */
1708 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
1709 if (loc != bl
1710 && loc->watchpoint_type == hw_access
1711 && watchpoint_locations_match (bl, loc))
1712 {
1713 bl->duplicate = 1;
1714 bl->inserted = 1;
1715 bl->target_info = loc->target_info;
1716 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
1717 val = 0;
1718 break;
1719 }
1720
1721 if (val == 1)
1722 {
1723 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
1724 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
1725
1726 if (val)
1727 /* Back to the original value. */
1728 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_read;
1729 }
1730 }
1731
1732 bl->inserted = (val == 0);
1733 }
1734
1735 else if (bl->owner->type == bp_catchpoint)
1736 {
1737 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
1738 && bl->owner->ops->insert_location != NULL);
1739
1740 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
1741 if (val)
1742 {
1743 bl->owner->enable_state = bp_disabled;
1744
1745 if (val == 1)
1746 warning (_("\
1747 Error inserting catchpoint %d: Your system does not support this type\n\
1748 of catchpoint."), bl->owner->number);
1749 else
1750 warning (_("Error inserting catchpoint %d."), bl->owner->number);
1751 }
1752
1753 bl->inserted = (val == 0);
1754
1755 /* We've already printed an error message if there was a problem
1756 inserting this catchpoint, and we've disabled the catchpoint,
1757 so just return success. */
1758 return 0;
1759 }
1760
1761 return 0;
1762 }
1763
1764 /* This function is called when program space PSPACE is about to be
1765 deleted. It takes care of updating breakpoints to not reference
1766 PSPACE anymore. */
1767
1768 void
1769 breakpoint_program_space_exit (struct program_space *pspace)
1770 {
1771 struct breakpoint *b, *b_temp;
1772 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
1773
1774 /* Remove any breakpoint that was set through this program space. */
1775 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_temp)
1776 {
1777 if (b->pspace == pspace)
1778 delete_breakpoint (b);
1779 }
1780
1781 /* Breakpoints set through other program spaces could have locations
1782 bound to PSPACE as well. Remove those. */
1783 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
1784 {
1785 struct bp_location *tmp;
1786
1787 if (loc->pspace == pspace)
1788 {
1789 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
1790 if (loc->owner->loc == loc)
1791 loc->owner->loc = loc->next;
1792 else
1793 for (tmp = loc->owner->loc; tmp->next != NULL; tmp = tmp->next)
1794 if (tmp->next == loc)
1795 {
1796 tmp->next = loc->next;
1797 break;
1798 }
1799 }
1800 }
1801
1802 /* Now update the global location list to permanently delete the
1803 removed locations above. */
1804 update_global_location_list (0);
1805 }
1806
1807 /* Make sure all breakpoints are inserted in inferior.
1808 Throws exception on any error.
1809 A breakpoint that is already inserted won't be inserted
1810 again, so calling this function twice is safe. */
1811 void
1812 insert_breakpoints (void)
1813 {
1814 struct breakpoint *bpt;
1815
1816 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
1817 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
1818 update_watchpoint (bpt, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
1819
1820 update_global_location_list (1);
1821
1822 /* update_global_location_list does not insert breakpoints when
1823 always_inserted_mode is not enabled. Explicitly insert them
1824 now. */
1825 if (!breakpoints_always_inserted_mode ())
1826 insert_breakpoint_locations ();
1827 }
1828
1829 /* insert_breakpoints is used when starting or continuing the program.
1830 remove_breakpoints is used when the program stops.
1831 Both return zero if successful,
1832 or an `errno' value if could not write the inferior. */
1833
1834 static void
1835 insert_breakpoint_locations (void)
1836 {
1837 struct breakpoint *bpt;
1838 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
1839 int error = 0;
1840 int val = 0;
1841 int disabled_breaks = 0;
1842 int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
1843
1844 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream = mem_fileopen ();
1845 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (tmp_error_stream);
1846
1847 /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
1848 there was an error. */
1849 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, "Warning:\n");
1850
1851 save_current_space_and_thread ();
1852
1853 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
1854 {
1855 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || bl->inserted)
1856 continue;
1857
1858 /* There is no point inserting thread-specific breakpoints if
1859 the thread no longer exists. ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location
1860 has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
1861 if (bl->owner->thread != -1
1862 && !valid_thread_id (bl->owner->thread))
1863 continue;
1864
1865 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
1866
1867 /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
1868 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
1869 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
1870 insert breakpoints. */
1871 if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch)
1872 && ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
1873 continue;
1874
1875 val = insert_bp_location (bl, tmp_error_stream, &disabled_breaks,
1876 &hw_breakpoint_error);
1877 if (val)
1878 error = val;
1879 }
1880
1881 /* If we failed to insert all locations of a watchpoint, remove
1882 them, as half-inserted watchpoint is of limited use. */
1883 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
1884 {
1885 int some_failed = 0;
1886 struct bp_location *loc;
1887
1888 if (!is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
1889 continue;
1890
1891 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
1892 continue;
1893
1894 if (bpt->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1895 continue;
1896
1897 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
1898 if (!loc->inserted && should_be_inserted (loc))
1899 {
1900 some_failed = 1;
1901 break;
1902 }
1903 if (some_failed)
1904 {
1905 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
1906 if (loc->inserted)
1907 remove_breakpoint (loc, mark_uninserted);
1908
1909 hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
1910 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1911 "Could not insert hardware watchpoint %d.\n",
1912 bpt->number);
1913 error = -1;
1914 }
1915 }
1916
1917 if (error)
1918 {
1919 /* If a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint was inserted, add a
1920 message about possibly exhausted resources. */
1921 if (hw_breakpoint_error)
1922 {
1923 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1924 "Could not insert hardware breakpoints:\n\
1925 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints/watchpoints.\n");
1926 }
1927 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
1928 error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
1929 }
1930
1931 do_cleanups (cleanups);
1932 }
1933
1934 int
1935 remove_breakpoints (void)
1936 {
1937 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
1938 int val = 0;
1939
1940 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
1941 {
1942 if (bl->inserted)
1943 val |= remove_breakpoint (bl, mark_uninserted);
1944 }
1945 return val;
1946 }
1947
1948 /* Remove breakpoints of process PID. */
1949
1950 int
1951 remove_breakpoints_pid (int pid)
1952 {
1953 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
1954 int val;
1955 struct inferior *inf = find_inferior_pid (pid);
1956
1957 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
1958 {
1959 if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
1960 continue;
1961
1962 if (bl->inserted)
1963 {
1964 val = remove_breakpoint (bl, mark_uninserted);
1965 if (val != 0)
1966 return val;
1967 }
1968 }
1969 return 0;
1970 }
1971
1972 int
1973 remove_hw_watchpoints (void)
1974 {
1975 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
1976 int val = 0;
1977
1978 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
1979 {
1980 if (bl->inserted && bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
1981 val |= remove_breakpoint (bl, mark_uninserted);
1982 }
1983 return val;
1984 }
1985
1986 int
1987 reattach_breakpoints (int pid)
1988 {
1989 struct cleanup *old_chain;
1990 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
1991 int val;
1992 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream;
1993 int dummy1 = 0, dummy2 = 0;
1994 struct inferior *inf;
1995 struct thread_info *tp;
1996
1997 tp = any_live_thread_of_process (pid);
1998 if (tp == NULL)
1999 return 1;
2000
2001 inf = find_inferior_pid (pid);
2002 old_chain = save_inferior_ptid ();
2003
2004 inferior_ptid = tp->ptid;
2005
2006 tmp_error_stream = mem_fileopen ();
2007 make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (tmp_error_stream);
2008
2009 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
2010 {
2011 if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
2012 continue;
2013
2014 if (bl->inserted)
2015 {
2016 bl->inserted = 0;
2017 val = insert_bp_location (bl, tmp_error_stream, &dummy1, &dummy2);
2018 if (val != 0)
2019 {
2020 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2021 return val;
2022 }
2023 }
2024 }
2025 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2026 return 0;
2027 }
2028
2029 static int internal_breakpoint_number = -1;
2030
2031 /* Set the breakpoint number of B, depending on the value of INTERNAL.
2032 If INTERNAL is non-zero, the breakpoint number will be populated
2033 from internal_breakpoint_number and that variable decremented.
2034 Otherwis the breakpoint number will be populated from
2035 breakpoint_count and that value incremented. Internal breakpoints
2036 do not set the internal var bpnum. */
2037 static void
2038 set_breakpoint_number (int internal, struct breakpoint *b)
2039 {
2040 if (internal)
2041 b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
2042 else
2043 {
2044 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
2045 b->number = breakpoint_count;
2046 }
2047 }
2048
2049 static struct breakpoint *
2050 create_internal_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
2051 CORE_ADDR address, enum bptype type)
2052 {
2053 struct symtab_and_line sal;
2054 struct breakpoint *b;
2055
2056 init_sal (&sal); /* Initialize to zeroes. */
2057
2058 sal.pc = address;
2059 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (sal.pc);
2060 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
2061
2062 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type);
2063 b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
2064 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
2065
2066 return b;
2067 }
2068
2069 static const char *const longjmp_names[] =
2070 {
2071 "longjmp", "_longjmp", "siglongjmp", "_siglongjmp"
2072 };
2073 #define NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES ARRAY_SIZE(longjmp_names)
2074
2075 /* Per-objfile data private to breakpoint.c. */
2076 struct breakpoint_objfile_data
2077 {
2078 /* Minimal symbol for "_ovly_debug_event" (if any). */
2079 struct minimal_symbol *overlay_msym;
2080
2081 /* Minimal symbol(s) for "longjmp", "siglongjmp", etc. (if any). */
2082 struct minimal_symbol *longjmp_msym[NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES];
2083
2084 /* Minimal symbol for "std::terminate()" (if any). */
2085 struct minimal_symbol *terminate_msym;
2086
2087 /* Minimal symbol for "_Unwind_DebugHook" (if any). */
2088 struct minimal_symbol *exception_msym;
2089 };
2090
2091 static const struct objfile_data *breakpoint_objfile_key;
2092
2093 /* Minimal symbol not found sentinel. */
2094 static struct minimal_symbol msym_not_found;
2095
2096 /* Returns TRUE if MSYM point to the "not found" sentinel. */
2097
2098 static int
2099 msym_not_found_p (const struct minimal_symbol *msym)
2100 {
2101 return msym == &msym_not_found;
2102 }
2103
2104 /* Return per-objfile data needed by breakpoint.c.
2105 Allocate the data if necessary. */
2106
2107 static struct breakpoint_objfile_data *
2108 get_breakpoint_objfile_data (struct objfile *objfile)
2109 {
2110 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
2111
2112 bp_objfile_data = objfile_data (objfile, breakpoint_objfile_key);
2113 if (bp_objfile_data == NULL)
2114 {
2115 bp_objfile_data = obstack_alloc (&objfile->objfile_obstack,
2116 sizeof (*bp_objfile_data));
2117
2118 memset (bp_objfile_data, 0, sizeof (*bp_objfile_data));
2119 set_objfile_data (objfile, breakpoint_objfile_key, bp_objfile_data);
2120 }
2121 return bp_objfile_data;
2122 }
2123
2124 static void
2125 create_overlay_event_breakpoint (void)
2126 {
2127 struct objfile *objfile;
2128 const char *const func_name = "_ovly_debug_event";
2129
2130 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
2131 {
2132 struct breakpoint *b;
2133 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
2134 CORE_ADDR addr;
2135
2136 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
2137
2138 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym))
2139 continue;
2140
2141 if (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym == NULL)
2142 {
2143 struct minimal_symbol *m;
2144
2145 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
2146 if (m == NULL)
2147 {
2148 /* Avoid future lookups in this objfile. */
2149 bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym = &msym_not_found;
2150 continue;
2151 }
2152 bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym = m;
2153 }
2154
2155 addr = SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym);
2156 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile), addr,
2157 bp_overlay_event);
2158 b->addr_string = xstrdup (func_name);
2159
2160 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_auto)
2161 {
2162 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
2163 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
2164 }
2165 else
2166 {
2167 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
2168 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
2169 }
2170 }
2171 update_global_location_list (1);
2172 }
2173
2174 static void
2175 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint (void)
2176 {
2177 struct program_space *pspace;
2178 struct cleanup *old_chain;
2179
2180 old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
2181
2182 ALL_PSPACES (pspace)
2183 {
2184 struct objfile *objfile;
2185
2186 set_current_program_space (pspace);
2187
2188 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
2189 {
2190 int i;
2191 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
2192 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
2193
2194 gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
2195 if (!gdbarch_get_longjmp_target_p (gdbarch))
2196 continue;
2197
2198 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
2199
2200 for (i = 0; i < NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES; i++)
2201 {
2202 struct breakpoint *b;
2203 const char *func_name;
2204 CORE_ADDR addr;
2205
2206 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i]))
2207 continue;
2208
2209 func_name = longjmp_names[i];
2210 if (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i] == NULL)
2211 {
2212 struct minimal_symbol *m;
2213
2214 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
2215 if (m == NULL)
2216 {
2217 /* Prevent future lookups in this objfile. */
2218 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i] = &msym_not_found;
2219 continue;
2220 }
2221 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i] = m;
2222 }
2223
2224 addr = SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i]);
2225 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, addr, bp_longjmp_master);
2226 b->addr_string = xstrdup (func_name);
2227 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
2228 }
2229 }
2230 }
2231 update_global_location_list (1);
2232
2233 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2234 }
2235
2236 /* Create a master std::terminate breakpoint. */
2237 static void
2238 create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint (void)
2239 {
2240 struct program_space *pspace;
2241 struct cleanup *old_chain;
2242 const char *const func_name = "std::terminate()";
2243
2244 old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
2245
2246 ALL_PSPACES (pspace)
2247 {
2248 struct objfile *objfile;
2249 CORE_ADDR addr;
2250
2251 set_current_program_space (pspace);
2252
2253 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
2254 {
2255 struct breakpoint *b;
2256 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
2257
2258 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
2259
2260 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym))
2261 continue;
2262
2263 if (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym == NULL)
2264 {
2265 struct minimal_symbol *m;
2266
2267 m = lookup_minimal_symbol (func_name, NULL, objfile);
2268 if (m == NULL || (MSYMBOL_TYPE (m) != mst_text
2269 && MSYMBOL_TYPE (m) != mst_file_text))
2270 {
2271 /* Prevent future lookups in this objfile. */
2272 bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym = &msym_not_found;
2273 continue;
2274 }
2275 bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym = m;
2276 }
2277
2278 addr = SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym);
2279 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile), addr,
2280 bp_std_terminate_master);
2281 b->addr_string = xstrdup (func_name);
2282 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
2283 }
2284 }
2285
2286 update_global_location_list (1);
2287
2288 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2289 }
2290
2291 /* Install a master breakpoint on the unwinder's debug hook. */
2292
2293 void
2294 create_exception_master_breakpoint (void)
2295 {
2296 struct objfile *objfile;
2297 const char *const func_name = "_Unwind_DebugHook";
2298
2299 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
2300 {
2301 struct breakpoint *b;
2302 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
2303 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
2304 CORE_ADDR addr;
2305
2306 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
2307
2308 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym))
2309 continue;
2310
2311 gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
2312
2313 if (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym == NULL)
2314 {
2315 struct minimal_symbol *debug_hook;
2316
2317 debug_hook = lookup_minimal_symbol (func_name, NULL, objfile);
2318 if (debug_hook == NULL)
2319 {
2320 bp_objfile_data->exception_msym = &msym_not_found;
2321 continue;
2322 }
2323
2324 bp_objfile_data->exception_msym = debug_hook;
2325 }
2326
2327 addr = SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym);
2328 addr = gdbarch_convert_from_func_ptr_addr (gdbarch, addr,
2329 &current_target);
2330 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, addr, bp_exception_master);
2331 b->addr_string = xstrdup (func_name);
2332 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
2333 }
2334
2335 update_global_location_list (1);
2336 }
2337
2338 void
2339 update_breakpoints_after_exec (void)
2340 {
2341 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
2342 struct bp_location *bploc, **bplocp_tmp;
2343
2344 /* We're about to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists. If the
2345 INSERTED flag is true, GDB will try to lift the breakpoints by
2346 writing the breakpoints' "shadow contents" back into memory. The
2347 "shadow contents" are NOT valid after an exec, so GDB should not
2348 do that. Instead, the target is responsible from marking
2349 breakpoints out as soon as it detects an exec. We don't do that
2350 here instead, because there may be other attempts to delete
2351 breakpoints after detecting an exec and before reaching here. */
2352 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bploc, bplocp_tmp)
2353 if (bploc->pspace == current_program_space)
2354 gdb_assert (!bploc->inserted);
2355
2356 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
2357 {
2358 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
2359 continue;
2360
2361 /* Solib breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
2362 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
2363 {
2364 delete_breakpoint (b);
2365 continue;
2366 }
2367
2368 /* JIT breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
2369 if (b->type == bp_jit_event)
2370 {
2371 delete_breakpoint (b);
2372 continue;
2373 }
2374
2375 /* Thread event breakpoints must be set anew after an exec(),
2376 as must overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints. */
2377 if (b->type == bp_thread_event || b->type == bp_overlay_event
2378 || b->type == bp_longjmp_master || b->type == bp_std_terminate_master
2379 || b->type == bp_exception_master)
2380 {
2381 delete_breakpoint (b);
2382 continue;
2383 }
2384
2385 /* Step-resume breakpoints are meaningless after an exec(). */
2386 if (b->type == bp_step_resume)
2387 {
2388 delete_breakpoint (b);
2389 continue;
2390 }
2391
2392 /* Longjmp and longjmp-resume breakpoints are also meaningless
2393 after an exec. */
2394 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_longjmp_resume
2395 || b->type == bp_exception || b->type == bp_exception_resume)
2396 {
2397 delete_breakpoint (b);
2398 continue;
2399 }
2400
2401 if (b->type == bp_catchpoint)
2402 {
2403 /* For now, none of the bp_catchpoint breakpoints need to
2404 do anything at this point. In the future, if some of
2405 the catchpoints need to something, we will need to add
2406 a new method, and call this method from here. */
2407 continue;
2408 }
2409
2410 /* bp_finish is a special case. The only way we ought to be able
2411 to see one of these when an exec() has happened, is if the user
2412 caught a vfork, and then said "finish". Ordinarily a finish just
2413 carries them to the call-site of the current callee, by setting
2414 a temporary bp there and resuming. But in this case, the finish
2415 will carry them entirely through the vfork & exec.
2416
2417 We don't want to allow a bp_finish to remain inserted now. But
2418 we can't safely delete it, 'cause finish_command has a handle to
2419 the bp on a bpstat, and will later want to delete it. There's a
2420 chance (and I've seen it happen) that if we delete the bp_finish
2421 here, that its storage will get reused by the time finish_command
2422 gets 'round to deleting the "use to be a bp_finish" breakpoint.
2423 We really must allow finish_command to delete a bp_finish.
2424
2425 In the absense of a general solution for the "how do we know
2426 it's safe to delete something others may have handles to?"
2427 problem, what we'll do here is just uninsert the bp_finish, and
2428 let finish_command delete it.
2429
2430 (We know the bp_finish is "doomed" in the sense that it's
2431 momentary, and will be deleted as soon as finish_command sees
2432 the inferior stopped. So it doesn't matter that the bp's
2433 address is probably bogus in the new a.out, unlike e.g., the
2434 solib breakpoints.) */
2435
2436 if (b->type == bp_finish)
2437 {
2438 continue;
2439 }
2440
2441 /* Without a symbolic address, we have little hope of the
2442 pre-exec() address meaning the same thing in the post-exec()
2443 a.out. */
2444 if (b->addr_string == NULL)
2445 {
2446 delete_breakpoint (b);
2447 continue;
2448 }
2449 }
2450 /* FIXME what about longjmp breakpoints? Re-create them here? */
2451 create_overlay_event_breakpoint ();
2452 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ();
2453 create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint ();
2454 create_exception_master_breakpoint ();
2455 }
2456
2457 int
2458 detach_breakpoints (int pid)
2459 {
2460 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
2461 int val = 0;
2462 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_inferior_ptid ();
2463 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
2464
2465 if (pid == PIDGET (inferior_ptid))
2466 error (_("Cannot detach breakpoints of inferior_ptid"));
2467
2468 /* Set inferior_ptid; remove_breakpoint_1 uses this global. */
2469 inferior_ptid = pid_to_ptid (pid);
2470 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
2471 {
2472 if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
2473 continue;
2474
2475 if (bl->inserted)
2476 val |= remove_breakpoint_1 (bl, mark_inserted);
2477 }
2478
2479 /* Detach single-step breakpoints as well. */
2480 detach_single_step_breakpoints ();
2481
2482 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2483 return val;
2484 }
2485
2486 /* Remove the breakpoint location BL from the current address space.
2487 Note that this is used to detach breakpoints from a child fork.
2488 When we get here, the child isn't in the inferior list, and neither
2489 do we have objects to represent its address space --- we should
2490 *not* look at bl->pspace->aspace here. */
2491
2492 static int
2493 remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *bl, insertion_state_t is)
2494 {
2495 int val;
2496
2497 /* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers. */
2498 gdb_assert (bl->owner != NULL);
2499
2500 if (bl->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2501 /* Permanent breakpoints cannot be inserted or removed. */
2502 return 0;
2503
2504 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
2505 This should not ever happen. */
2506 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type != bp_none);
2507
2508 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2509 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2510 {
2511 /* "Normal" instruction breakpoint: either the standard
2512 trap-instruction bp (bp_breakpoint), or a
2513 bp_hardware_breakpoint. */
2514
2515 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
2516 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
2517 || bl->section == NULL
2518 || !(section_is_overlay (bl->section)))
2519 {
2520 /* No overlay handling: just remove the breakpoint. */
2521
2522 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2523 val = target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
2524 else
2525 val = target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
2526 }
2527 else
2528 {
2529 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
2530 Did we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
2531 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
2532 {
2533 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active, so we
2534 should have set a breakpoint at the LMA. Remove it.
2535 */
2536 /* Ignore any failures: if the LMA is in ROM, we will
2537 have already warned when we failed to insert it. */
2538 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2539 target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
2540 &bl->overlay_target_info);
2541 else
2542 target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
2543 &bl->overlay_target_info);
2544 }
2545 /* Did we set a breakpoint at the VMA?
2546 If so, we will have marked the breakpoint 'inserted'. */
2547 if (bl->inserted)
2548 {
2549 /* Yes -- remove it. Previously we did not bother to
2550 remove the breakpoint if the section had been
2551 unmapped, but let's not rely on that being safe. We
2552 don't know what the overlay manager might do. */
2553 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2554 val = target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
2555 &bl->target_info);
2556
2557 /* However, we should remove *software* breakpoints only
2558 if the section is still mapped, or else we overwrite
2559 wrong code with the saved shadow contents. */
2560 else if (section_is_mapped (bl->section))
2561 val = target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
2562 &bl->target_info);
2563 else
2564 val = 0;
2565 }
2566 else
2567 {
2568 /* No -- not inserted, so no need to remove. No error. */
2569 val = 0;
2570 }
2571 }
2572
2573 /* In some cases, we might not be able to remove a breakpoint
2574 in a shared library that has already been removed, but we
2575 have not yet processed the shlib unload event. */
2576 if (val && solib_name_from_address (bl->pspace, bl->address))
2577 val = 0;
2578
2579 if (val)
2580 return val;
2581 bl->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
2582 }
2583 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
2584 {
2585 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
2586 && bl->owner->ops->remove_location != NULL);
2587
2588 bl->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
2589 bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl);
2590
2591 /* Failure to remove any of the hardware watchpoints comes here. */
2592 if ((is == mark_uninserted) && (bl->inserted))
2593 warning (_("Could not remove hardware watchpoint %d."),
2594 bl->owner->number);
2595 }
2596 else if (bl->owner->type == bp_catchpoint
2597 && breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
2598 && !bl->duplicate)
2599 {
2600 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
2601 && bl->owner->ops->remove_location != NULL);
2602
2603 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl);
2604 if (val)
2605 return val;
2606
2607 bl->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
2608 }
2609
2610 return 0;
2611 }
2612
2613 static int
2614 remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *bl, insertion_state_t is)
2615 {
2616 int ret;
2617 struct cleanup *old_chain;
2618
2619 /* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers. */
2620 gdb_assert (bl->owner != NULL);
2621
2622 if (bl->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2623 /* Permanent breakpoints cannot be inserted or removed. */
2624 return 0;
2625
2626 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
2627 This should not ever happen. */
2628 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type != bp_none);
2629
2630 old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
2631
2632 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
2633
2634 ret = remove_breakpoint_1 (bl, is);
2635
2636 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2637 return ret;
2638 }
2639
2640 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints. */
2641
2642 void
2643 mark_breakpoints_out (void)
2644 {
2645 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
2646
2647 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
2648 if (bl->pspace == current_program_space)
2649 bl->inserted = 0;
2650 }
2651
2652 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints and delete any
2653 breakpoints which should go away between runs of the program.
2654
2655 Plus other such housekeeping that has to be done for breakpoints
2656 between runs.
2657
2658 Note: this function gets called at the end of a run (by
2659 generic_mourn_inferior) and when a run begins (by
2660 init_wait_for_inferior). */
2661
2662
2663
2664 void
2665 breakpoint_init_inferior (enum inf_context context)
2666 {
2667 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
2668 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
2669 int ix;
2670 struct program_space *pspace = current_program_space;
2671
2672 /* If breakpoint locations are shared across processes, then there's
2673 nothing to do. */
2674 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch))
2675 return;
2676
2677 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
2678 {
2679 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
2680 if (bl->pspace == pspace
2681 && bl->owner->enable_state != bp_permanent)
2682 bl->inserted = 0;
2683 }
2684
2685 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
2686 {
2687 if (b->loc && b->loc->pspace != pspace)
2688 continue;
2689
2690 switch (b->type)
2691 {
2692 case bp_call_dummy:
2693
2694 /* If the call dummy breakpoint is at the entry point it will
2695 cause problems when the inferior is rerun, so we better get
2696 rid of it. */
2697
2698 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
2699
2700 /* Also get rid of scope breakpoints. */
2701
2702 case bp_shlib_event:
2703
2704 /* Also remove solib event breakpoints. Their addresses may
2705 have changed since the last time we ran the program.
2706 Actually we may now be debugging against different target;
2707 and so the solib backend that installed this breakpoint may
2708 not be used in by the target. E.g.,
2709
2710 (gdb) file prog-linux
2711 (gdb) run # native linux target
2712 ...
2713 (gdb) kill
2714 (gdb) file prog-win.exe
2715 (gdb) tar rem :9999 # remote Windows gdbserver.
2716 */
2717
2718 delete_breakpoint (b);
2719 break;
2720
2721 case bp_watchpoint:
2722 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
2723 case bp_read_watchpoint:
2724 case bp_access_watchpoint:
2725
2726 /* Likewise for watchpoints on local expressions. */
2727 if (b->exp_valid_block != NULL)
2728 delete_breakpoint (b);
2729 else if (context == inf_starting)
2730 {
2731 /* Reset val field to force reread of starting value in
2732 insert_breakpoints. */
2733 if (b->val)
2734 value_free (b->val);
2735 b->val = NULL;
2736 b->val_valid = 0;
2737 }
2738 break;
2739 default:
2740 break;
2741 }
2742 }
2743
2744 /* Get rid of the moribund locations. */
2745 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, bl); ++ix)
2746 decref_bp_location (&bl);
2747 VEC_free (bp_location_p, moribund_locations);
2748 }
2749
2750 /* These functions concern about actual breakpoints inserted in the
2751 target --- to e.g. check if we need to do decr_pc adjustment or if
2752 we need to hop over the bkpt --- so we check for address space
2753 match, not program space. */
2754
2755 /* breakpoint_here_p (PC) returns non-zero if an enabled breakpoint
2756 exists at PC. It returns ordinary_breakpoint_here if it's an
2757 ordinary breakpoint, or permanent_breakpoint_here if it's a
2758 permanent breakpoint.
2759 - When continuing from a location with an ordinary breakpoint, we
2760 actually single step once before calling insert_breakpoints.
2761 - When continuing from a localion with a permanent breakpoint, we
2762 need to use the `SKIP_PERMANENT_BREAKPOINT' macro, provided by
2763 the target, to advance the PC past the breakpoint. */
2764
2765 enum breakpoint_here
2766 breakpoint_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2767 {
2768 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
2769 int any_breakpoint_here = 0;
2770
2771 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
2772 {
2773 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2774 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2775 continue;
2776
2777 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has bl->OWNER always non-NULL. */
2778 if ((breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
2779 || bl->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2780 && breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
2781 aspace, pc))
2782 {
2783 if (overlay_debugging
2784 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
2785 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
2786 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2787 else if (bl->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2788 return permanent_breakpoint_here;
2789 else
2790 any_breakpoint_here = 1;
2791 }
2792 }
2793
2794 return any_breakpoint_here ? ordinary_breakpoint_here : 0;
2795 }
2796
2797 /* Return true if there's a moribund breakpoint at PC. */
2798
2799 int
2800 moribund_breakpoint_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2801 {
2802 struct bp_location *loc;
2803 int ix;
2804
2805 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
2806 if (breakpoint_address_match (loc->pspace->aspace, loc->address,
2807 aspace, pc))
2808 return 1;
2809
2810 return 0;
2811 }
2812
2813 /* Returns non-zero if there's a breakpoint inserted at PC, which is
2814 inserted using regular breakpoint_chain / bp_location array
2815 mechanism. This does not check for single-step breakpoints, which
2816 are inserted and removed using direct target manipulation. */
2817
2818 int
2819 regular_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace,
2820 CORE_ADDR pc)
2821 {
2822 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
2823
2824 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
2825 {
2826 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2827 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2828 continue;
2829
2830 if (bl->inserted
2831 && breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
2832 aspace, pc))
2833 {
2834 if (overlay_debugging
2835 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
2836 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
2837 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2838 else
2839 return 1;
2840 }
2841 }
2842 return 0;
2843 }
2844
2845 /* Returns non-zero iff there's either regular breakpoint
2846 or a single step breakpoint inserted at PC. */
2847
2848 int
2849 breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2850 {
2851 if (regular_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (aspace, pc))
2852 return 1;
2853
2854 if (single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (aspace, pc))
2855 return 1;
2856
2857 return 0;
2858 }
2859
2860 /* This function returns non-zero iff there is a software breakpoint
2861 inserted at PC. */
2862
2863 int
2864 software_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace,
2865 CORE_ADDR pc)
2866 {
2867 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
2868
2869 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
2870 {
2871 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
2872 continue;
2873
2874 if (bl->inserted
2875 && breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
2876 aspace, pc))
2877 {
2878 if (overlay_debugging
2879 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
2880 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
2881 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2882 else
2883 return 1;
2884 }
2885 }
2886
2887 /* Also check for software single-step breakpoints. */
2888 if (single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (aspace, pc))
2889 return 1;
2890
2891 return 0;
2892 }
2893
2894 int
2895 hardware_watchpoint_inserted_in_range (struct address_space *aspace,
2896 CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len)
2897 {
2898 struct breakpoint *bpt;
2899
2900 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
2901 {
2902 struct bp_location *loc;
2903
2904 if (bpt->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
2905 && bpt->type != bp_access_watchpoint)
2906 continue;
2907
2908 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
2909 continue;
2910
2911 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
2912 if (loc->pspace->aspace == aspace && loc->inserted)
2913 {
2914 CORE_ADDR l, h;
2915
2916 /* Check for intersection. */
2917 l = max (loc->address, addr);
2918 h = min (loc->address + loc->length, addr + len);
2919 if (l < h)
2920 return 1;
2921 }
2922 }
2923 return 0;
2924 }
2925
2926 /* breakpoint_thread_match (PC, PTID) returns true if the breakpoint at
2927 PC is valid for process/thread PTID. */
2928
2929 int
2930 breakpoint_thread_match (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
2931 ptid_t ptid)
2932 {
2933 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
2934 /* The thread and task IDs associated to PTID, computed lazily. */
2935 int thread = -1;
2936 int task = 0;
2937
2938 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
2939 {
2940 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2941 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2942 continue;
2943
2944 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has bl->OWNER always non-NULL. */
2945 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
2946 && bl->owner->enable_state != bp_permanent)
2947 continue;
2948
2949 if (!breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
2950 aspace, pc))
2951 continue;
2952
2953 if (bl->owner->thread != -1)
2954 {
2955 /* This is a thread-specific breakpoint. Check that ptid
2956 matches that thread. If thread hasn't been computed yet,
2957 it is now time to do so. */
2958 if (thread == -1)
2959 thread = pid_to_thread_id (ptid);
2960 if (bl->owner->thread != thread)
2961 continue;
2962 }
2963
2964 if (bl->owner->task != 0)
2965 {
2966 /* This is a task-specific breakpoint. Check that ptid
2967 matches that task. If task hasn't been computed yet,
2968 it is now time to do so. */
2969 if (task == 0)
2970 task = ada_get_task_number (ptid);
2971 if (bl->owner->task != task)
2972 continue;
2973 }
2974
2975 if (overlay_debugging
2976 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
2977 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
2978 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2979
2980 return 1;
2981 }
2982
2983 return 0;
2984 }
2985 \f
2986
2987 /* bpstat stuff. External routines' interfaces are documented
2988 in breakpoint.h. */
2989
2990 int
2991 ep_is_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *ep)
2992 {
2993 return (ep->type == bp_catchpoint);
2994 }
2995
2996 /* Frees any storage that is part of a bpstat. Does not walk the
2997 'next' chain. */
2998
2999 static void
3000 bpstat_free (bpstat bs)
3001 {
3002 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
3003 value_free (bs->old_val);
3004 decref_counted_command_line (&bs->commands);
3005 decref_bp_location (&bs->bp_location_at);
3006 xfree (bs);
3007 }
3008
3009 /* Clear a bpstat so that it says we are not at any breakpoint.
3010 Also free any storage that is part of a bpstat. */
3011
3012 void
3013 bpstat_clear (bpstat *bsp)
3014 {
3015 bpstat p;
3016 bpstat q;
3017
3018 if (bsp == 0)
3019 return;
3020 p = *bsp;
3021 while (p != NULL)
3022 {
3023 q = p->next;
3024 bpstat_free (p);
3025 p = q;
3026 }
3027 *bsp = NULL;
3028 }
3029
3030 /* Return a copy of a bpstat. Like "bs1 = bs2" but all storage that
3031 is part of the bpstat is copied as well. */
3032
3033 bpstat
3034 bpstat_copy (bpstat bs)
3035 {
3036 bpstat p = NULL;
3037 bpstat tmp;
3038 bpstat retval = NULL;
3039
3040 if (bs == NULL)
3041 return bs;
3042
3043 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
3044 {
3045 tmp = (bpstat) xmalloc (sizeof (*tmp));
3046 memcpy (tmp, bs, sizeof (*tmp));
3047 incref_counted_command_line (tmp->commands);
3048 incref_bp_location (tmp->bp_location_at);
3049 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
3050 {
3051 tmp->old_val = value_copy (bs->old_val);
3052 release_value (tmp->old_val);
3053 }
3054
3055 if (p == NULL)
3056 /* This is the first thing in the chain. */
3057 retval = tmp;
3058 else
3059 p->next = tmp;
3060 p = tmp;
3061 }
3062 p->next = NULL;
3063 return retval;
3064 }
3065
3066 /* Find the bpstat associated with this breakpoint. */
3067
3068 bpstat
3069 bpstat_find_breakpoint (bpstat bsp, struct breakpoint *breakpoint)
3070 {
3071 if (bsp == NULL)
3072 return NULL;
3073
3074 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
3075 {
3076 if (bsp->breakpoint_at == breakpoint)
3077 return bsp;
3078 }
3079 return NULL;
3080 }
3081
3082 /* Put in *NUM the breakpoint number of the first breakpoint we are
3083 stopped at. *BSP upon return is a bpstat which points to the
3084 remaining breakpoints stopped at (but which is not guaranteed to be
3085 good for anything but further calls to bpstat_num).
3086
3087 Return 0 if passed a bpstat which does not indicate any breakpoints.
3088 Return -1 if stopped at a breakpoint that has been deleted since
3089 we set it.
3090 Return 1 otherwise. */
3091
3092 int
3093 bpstat_num (bpstat *bsp, int *num)
3094 {
3095 struct breakpoint *b;
3096
3097 if ((*bsp) == NULL)
3098 return 0; /* No more breakpoint values */
3099
3100 /* We assume we'll never have several bpstats that correspond to a
3101 single breakpoint -- otherwise, this function might return the
3102 same number more than once and this will look ugly. */
3103 b = (*bsp)->breakpoint_at;
3104 *bsp = (*bsp)->next;
3105 if (b == NULL)
3106 return -1; /* breakpoint that's been deleted since */
3107
3108 *num = b->number; /* We have its number */
3109 return 1;
3110 }
3111
3112 /* Modify BS so that the actions will not be performed. */
3113
3114 void
3115 bpstat_clear_actions (bpstat bs)
3116 {
3117 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
3118 {
3119 decref_counted_command_line (&bs->commands);
3120 bs->commands_left = NULL;
3121 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
3122 {
3123 value_free (bs->old_val);
3124 bs->old_val = NULL;
3125 }
3126 }
3127 }
3128
3129 /* Called when a command is about to proceed the inferior. */
3130
3131 static void
3132 breakpoint_about_to_proceed (void)
3133 {
3134 if (!ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
3135 {
3136 struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
3137
3138 /* Allow inferior function calls in breakpoint commands to not
3139 interrupt the command list. When the call finishes
3140 successfully, the inferior will be standing at the same
3141 breakpoint as if nothing happened. */
3142 if (tp->control.in_infcall)
3143 return;
3144 }
3145
3146 breakpoint_proceeded = 1;
3147 }
3148
3149 /* Stub for cleaning up our state if we error-out of a breakpoint
3150 command. */
3151 static void
3152 cleanup_executing_breakpoints (void *ignore)
3153 {
3154 executing_breakpoint_commands = 0;
3155 }
3156
3157 /* Execute all the commands associated with all the breakpoints at
3158 this location. Any of these commands could cause the process to
3159 proceed beyond this point, etc. We look out for such changes by
3160 checking the global "breakpoint_proceeded" after each command.
3161
3162 Returns true if a breakpoint command resumed the inferior. In that
3163 case, it is the caller's responsibility to recall it again with the
3164 bpstat of the current thread. */
3165
3166 static int
3167 bpstat_do_actions_1 (bpstat *bsp)
3168 {
3169 bpstat bs;
3170 struct cleanup *old_chain;
3171 int again = 0;
3172
3173 /* Avoid endless recursion if a `source' command is contained
3174 in bs->commands. */
3175 if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
3176 return 0;
3177
3178 executing_breakpoint_commands = 1;
3179 old_chain = make_cleanup (cleanup_executing_breakpoints, 0);
3180
3181 /* This pointer will iterate over the list of bpstat's. */
3182 bs = *bsp;
3183
3184 breakpoint_proceeded = 0;
3185 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
3186 {
3187 struct counted_command_line *ccmd;
3188 struct command_line *cmd;
3189 struct cleanup *this_cmd_tree_chain;
3190
3191 /* Take ownership of the BSP's command tree, if it has one.
3192
3193 The command tree could legitimately contain commands like
3194 'step' and 'next', which call clear_proceed_status, which
3195 frees stop_bpstat's command tree. To make sure this doesn't
3196 free the tree we're executing out from under us, we need to
3197 take ownership of the tree ourselves. Since a given bpstat's
3198 commands are only executed once, we don't need to copy it; we
3199 can clear the pointer in the bpstat, and make sure we free
3200 the tree when we're done. */
3201 ccmd = bs->commands;
3202 bs->commands = NULL;
3203 this_cmd_tree_chain
3204 = make_cleanup_decref_counted_command_line (&ccmd);
3205 cmd = bs->commands_left;
3206 bs->commands_left = NULL;
3207
3208 while (cmd != NULL)
3209 {
3210 execute_control_command (cmd);
3211
3212 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
3213 break;
3214 else
3215 cmd = cmd->next;
3216 }
3217
3218 /* We can free this command tree now. */
3219 do_cleanups (this_cmd_tree_chain);
3220
3221 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
3222 {
3223 if (target_can_async_p ())
3224 /* If we are in async mode, then the target might be still
3225 running, not stopped at any breakpoint, so nothing for
3226 us to do here -- just return to the event loop. */
3227 ;
3228 else
3229 /* In sync mode, when execute_control_command returns
3230 we're already standing on the next breakpoint.
3231 Breakpoint commands for that stop were not run, since
3232 execute_command does not run breakpoint commands --
3233 only command_line_handler does, but that one is not
3234 involved in execution of breakpoint commands. So, we
3235 can now execute breakpoint commands. It should be
3236 noted that making execute_command do bpstat actions is
3237 not an option -- in this case we'll have recursive
3238 invocation of bpstat for each breakpoint with a
3239 command, and can easily blow up GDB stack. Instead, we
3240 return true, which will trigger the caller to recall us
3241 with the new stop_bpstat. */
3242 again = 1;
3243 break;
3244 }
3245 }
3246 do_cleanups (old_chain);
3247 return again;
3248 }
3249
3250 void
3251 bpstat_do_actions (void)
3252 {
3253 /* Do any commands attached to breakpoint we are stopped at. */
3254 while (!ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid)
3255 && target_has_execution
3256 && !is_exited (inferior_ptid)
3257 && !is_executing (inferior_ptid))
3258 /* Since in sync mode, bpstat_do_actions may resume the inferior,
3259 and only return when it is stopped at the next breakpoint, we
3260 keep doing breakpoint actions until it returns false to
3261 indicate the inferior was not resumed. */
3262 if (!bpstat_do_actions_1 (&inferior_thread ()->control.stop_bpstat))
3263 break;
3264 }
3265
3266 /* Print out the (old or new) value associated with a watchpoint. */
3267
3268 static void
3269 watchpoint_value_print (struct value *val, struct ui_file *stream)
3270 {
3271 if (val == NULL)
3272 fprintf_unfiltered (stream, _("<unreadable>"));
3273 else
3274 {
3275 struct value_print_options opts;
3276 get_user_print_options (&opts);
3277 value_print (val, stream, &opts);
3278 }
3279 }
3280
3281 /* This is the normal print function for a bpstat. In the future,
3282 much of this logic could (should?) be moved to bpstat_stop_status,
3283 by having it set different print_it values.
3284
3285 Current scheme: When we stop, bpstat_print() is called. It loops
3286 through the bpstat list of things causing this stop, calling the
3287 print_bp_stop_message function on each one. The behavior of the
3288 print_bp_stop_message function depends on the print_it field of
3289 bpstat. If such field so indicates, call this function here.
3290
3291 Return values from this routine (ultimately used by bpstat_print()
3292 and normal_stop() to decide what to do):
3293 PRINT_NOTHING: Means we already printed all we needed to print,
3294 don't print anything else.
3295 PRINT_SRC_ONLY: Means we printed something, and we do *not* desire
3296 that something to be followed by a location.
3297 PRINT_SCR_AND_LOC: Means we printed something, and we *do* desire
3298 that something to be followed by a location.
3299 PRINT_UNKNOWN: Means we printed nothing or we need to do some more
3300 analysis. */
3301
3302 static enum print_stop_action
3303 print_it_typical (bpstat bs)
3304 {
3305 struct cleanup *old_chain;
3306 struct breakpoint *b;
3307 const struct bp_location *bl;
3308 struct ui_stream *stb;
3309 int bp_temp = 0;
3310 enum print_stop_action result;
3311
3312 gdb_assert (bs->bp_location_at != NULL);
3313
3314 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
3315 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
3316
3317 stb = ui_out_stream_new (uiout);
3318 old_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_stream_delete (stb);
3319
3320 switch (b->type)
3321 {
3322 case bp_breakpoint:
3323 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
3324 bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
3325 if (bl->address != bl->requested_address)
3326 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bl->requested_address,
3327 bl->address,
3328 b->number, 1);
3329 annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
3330 if (bp_temp)
3331 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nTemporary breakpoint ");
3332 else
3333 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nBreakpoint ");
3334 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3335 {
3336 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
3337 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
3338 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
3339 }
3340 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
3341 ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
3342 result = PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
3343 break;
3344
3345 case bp_shlib_event:
3346 /* Did we stop because the user set the stop_on_solib_events
3347 variable? (If so, we report this as a generic, "Stopped due
3348 to shlib event" message.) */
3349 printf_filtered (_("Stopped due to shared library event\n"));
3350 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
3351 break;
3352
3353 case bp_thread_event:
3354 /* Not sure how we will get here.
3355 GDB should not stop for these breakpoints. */
3356 printf_filtered (_("Thread Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
3357 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
3358 break;
3359
3360 case bp_overlay_event:
3361 /* By analogy with the thread event, GDB should not stop for these. */
3362 printf_filtered (_("Overlay Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
3363 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
3364 break;
3365
3366 case bp_longjmp_master:
3367 /* These should never be enabled. */
3368 printf_filtered (_("Longjmp Master Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
3369 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
3370 break;
3371
3372 case bp_std_terminate_master:
3373 /* These should never be enabled. */
3374 printf_filtered (_("std::terminate Master Breakpoint: "
3375 "gdb should not stop!\n"));
3376 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
3377 break;
3378
3379 case bp_exception_master:
3380 /* These should never be enabled. */
3381 printf_filtered (_("Exception Master Breakpoint: "
3382 "gdb should not stop!\n"));
3383 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
3384 break;
3385
3386 case bp_watchpoint:
3387 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
3388 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
3389 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3390 ui_out_field_string
3391 (uiout, "reason",
3392 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
3393 mention (b);
3394 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
3395 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nOld value = ");
3396 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val, stb->stream);
3397 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "old", stb);
3398 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nNew value = ");
3399 watchpoint_value_print (b->val, stb->stream);
3400 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "new", stb);
3401 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
3402 /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
3403 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3404 break;
3405
3406 case bp_read_watchpoint:
3407 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3408 ui_out_field_string
3409 (uiout, "reason",
3410 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
3411 mention (b);
3412 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
3413 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nValue = ");
3414 watchpoint_value_print (b->val, stb->stream);
3415 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "value", stb);
3416 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
3417 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3418 break;
3419
3420 case bp_access_watchpoint:
3421 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
3422 {
3423 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
3424 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3425 ui_out_field_string
3426 (uiout, "reason",
3427 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
3428 mention (b);
3429 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
3430 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nOld value = ");
3431 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val, stb->stream);
3432 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "old", stb);
3433 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nNew value = ");
3434 }
3435 else
3436 {
3437 mention (b);
3438 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3439 ui_out_field_string
3440 (uiout, "reason",
3441 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
3442 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
3443 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nValue = ");
3444 }
3445 watchpoint_value_print (b->val, stb->stream);
3446 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "new", stb);
3447 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
3448 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3449 break;
3450
3451 /* Fall through, we don't deal with these types of breakpoints
3452 here. */
3453
3454 case bp_finish:
3455 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3456 ui_out_field_string
3457 (uiout, "reason",
3458 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_FUNCTION_FINISHED));
3459 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3460 break;
3461
3462 case bp_until:
3463 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3464 ui_out_field_string
3465 (uiout, "reason",
3466 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_LOCATION_REACHED));
3467 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3468 break;
3469
3470 case bp_none:
3471 case bp_longjmp:
3472 case bp_longjmp_resume:
3473 case bp_exception:
3474 case bp_exception_resume:
3475 case bp_step_resume:
3476 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
3477 case bp_call_dummy:
3478 case bp_std_terminate:
3479 case bp_tracepoint:
3480 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
3481 case bp_jit_event:
3482 default:
3483 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3484 break;
3485 }
3486
3487 do_cleanups (old_chain);
3488 return result;
3489 }
3490
3491 /* Generic routine for printing messages indicating why we
3492 stopped. The behavior of this function depends on the value
3493 'print_it' in the bpstat structure. Under some circumstances we
3494 may decide not to print anything here and delegate the task to
3495 normal_stop(). */
3496
3497 static enum print_stop_action
3498 print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs)
3499 {
3500 switch (bs->print_it)
3501 {
3502 case print_it_noop:
3503 /* Nothing should be printed for this bpstat entry. */
3504 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3505 break;
3506
3507 case print_it_done:
3508 /* We still want to print the frame, but we already printed the
3509 relevant messages. */
3510 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
3511 break;
3512
3513 case print_it_normal:
3514 {
3515 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
3516
3517 /* bs->breakpoint_at can be NULL if it was a momentary breakpoint
3518 which has since been deleted. */
3519 if (b == NULL)
3520 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3521
3522 /* Normal case. Call the breakpoint's print_it method, or
3523 print_it_typical. */
3524 if (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_it != NULL)
3525 return b->ops->print_it (b);
3526 else
3527 return print_it_typical (bs);
3528 }
3529 break;
3530
3531 default:
3532 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
3533 _("print_bp_stop_message: unrecognized enum value"));
3534 break;
3535 }
3536 }
3537
3538 /* Print a message indicating what happened. This is called from
3539 normal_stop(). The input to this routine is the head of the bpstat
3540 list - a list of the eventpoints that caused this stop. This
3541 routine calls the generic print routine for printing a message
3542 about reasons for stopping. This will print (for example) the
3543 "Breakpoint n," part of the output. The return value of this
3544 routine is one of:
3545
3546 PRINT_UNKNOWN: Means we printed nothing.
3547 PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC: Means we printed something, and expect subsequent
3548 code to print the location. An example is
3549 "Breakpoint 1, " which should be followed by
3550 the location.
3551 PRINT_SRC_ONLY: Means we printed something, but there is no need
3552 to also print the location part of the message.
3553 An example is the catch/throw messages, which
3554 don't require a location appended to the end.
3555 PRINT_NOTHING: We have done some printing and we don't need any
3556 further info to be printed. */
3557
3558 enum print_stop_action
3559 bpstat_print (bpstat bs)
3560 {
3561 int val;
3562
3563 /* Maybe another breakpoint in the chain caused us to stop.
3564 (Currently all watchpoints go on the bpstat whether hit or not.
3565 That probably could (should) be changed, provided care is taken
3566 with respect to bpstat_explains_signal). */
3567 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
3568 {
3569 val = print_bp_stop_message (bs);
3570 if (val == PRINT_SRC_ONLY
3571 || val == PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC
3572 || val == PRINT_NOTHING)
3573 return val;
3574 }
3575
3576 /* We reached the end of the chain, or we got a null BS to start
3577 with and nothing was printed. */
3578 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3579 }
3580
3581 /* Evaluate the expression EXP and return 1 if value is zero. This is
3582 used inside a catch_errors to evaluate the breakpoint condition.
3583 The argument is a "struct expression *" that has been cast to a
3584 "char *" to make it pass through catch_errors. */
3585
3586 static int
3587 breakpoint_cond_eval (void *exp)
3588 {
3589 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
3590 int i = !value_true (evaluate_expression ((struct expression *) exp));
3591
3592 value_free_to_mark (mark);
3593 return i;
3594 }
3595
3596 /* Allocate a new bpstat. Link it to the FIFO list by BS_LINK_POINTER. */
3597
3598 static bpstat
3599 bpstat_alloc (struct bp_location *bl, bpstat **bs_link_pointer)
3600 {
3601 bpstat bs;
3602
3603 bs = (bpstat) xmalloc (sizeof (*bs));
3604 bs->next = NULL;
3605 **bs_link_pointer = bs;
3606 *bs_link_pointer = &bs->next;
3607 bs->breakpoint_at = bl->owner;
3608 bs->bp_location_at = bl;
3609 incref_bp_location (bl);
3610 /* If the condition is false, etc., don't do the commands. */
3611 bs->commands = NULL;
3612 bs->commands_left = NULL;
3613 bs->old_val = NULL;
3614 bs->print_it = print_it_normal;
3615 return bs;
3616 }
3617 \f
3618 /* The target has stopped with waitstatus WS. Check if any hardware
3619 watchpoints have triggered, according to the target. */
3620
3621 int
3622 watchpoints_triggered (struct target_waitstatus *ws)
3623 {
3624 int stopped_by_watchpoint = target_stopped_by_watchpoint ();
3625 CORE_ADDR addr;
3626 struct breakpoint *b;
3627
3628 if (!stopped_by_watchpoint)
3629 {
3630 /* We were not stopped by a watchpoint. Mark all watchpoints
3631 as not triggered. */
3632 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3633 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
3634 b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
3635
3636 return 0;
3637 }
3638
3639 if (!target_stopped_data_address (&current_target, &addr))
3640 {
3641 /* We were stopped by a watchpoint, but we don't know where.
3642 Mark all watchpoints as unknown. */
3643 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3644 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
3645 b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_unknown;
3646
3647 return stopped_by_watchpoint;
3648 }
3649
3650 /* The target could report the data address. Mark watchpoints
3651 affected by this data address as triggered, and all others as not
3652 triggered. */
3653
3654 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3655 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
3656 {
3657 struct bp_location *loc;
3658
3659 b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
3660 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
3661 /* Exact match not required. Within range is
3662 sufficient. */
3663 if (target_watchpoint_addr_within_range (&current_target,
3664 addr, loc->address,
3665 loc->length))
3666 {
3667 b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
3668 break;
3669 }
3670 }
3671
3672 return 1;
3673 }
3674
3675 /* Possible return values for watchpoint_check (this can't be an enum
3676 because of check_errors). */
3677 /* The watchpoint has been deleted. */
3678 #define WP_DELETED 1
3679 /* The value has changed. */
3680 #define WP_VALUE_CHANGED 2
3681 /* The value has not changed. */
3682 #define WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED 3
3683 /* Ignore this watchpoint, no matter if the value changed or not. */
3684 #define WP_IGNORE 4
3685
3686 #define BP_TEMPFLAG 1
3687 #define BP_HARDWAREFLAG 2
3688
3689 /* Evaluate watchpoint condition expression and check if its value
3690 changed.
3691
3692 P should be a pointer to struct bpstat, but is defined as a void *
3693 in order for this function to be usable with catch_errors. */
3694
3695 static int
3696 watchpoint_check (void *p)
3697 {
3698 bpstat bs = (bpstat) p;
3699 struct breakpoint *b;
3700 struct frame_info *fr;
3701 int within_current_scope;
3702
3703 /* BS is built from an existing struct breakpoint. */
3704 gdb_assert (bs->breakpoint_at != NULL);
3705 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
3706
3707 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
3708 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
3709 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
3710 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
3711 return WP_IGNORE;
3712
3713 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
3714 within_current_scope = 1;
3715 else
3716 {
3717 struct frame_info *frame = get_current_frame ();
3718 struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (frame);
3719 CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (frame);
3720
3721 /* in_function_epilogue_p() returns a non-zero value if we're
3722 still in the function but the stack frame has already been
3723 invalidated. Since we can't rely on the values of local
3724 variables after the stack has been destroyed, we are treating
3725 the watchpoint in that state as `not changed' without further
3726 checking. Don't mark watchpoints as changed if the current
3727 frame is in an epilogue - even if they are in some other
3728 frame, our view of the stack is likely to be wrong and
3729 frame_find_by_id could error out. */
3730 if (gdbarch_in_function_epilogue_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
3731 return WP_IGNORE;
3732
3733 fr = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
3734 within_current_scope = (fr != NULL);
3735
3736 /* If we've gotten confused in the unwinder, we might have
3737 returned a frame that can't describe this variable. */
3738 if (within_current_scope)
3739 {
3740 struct symbol *function;
3741
3742 function = get_frame_function (fr);
3743 if (function == NULL
3744 || !contained_in (b->exp_valid_block,
3745 SYMBOL_BLOCK_VALUE (function)))
3746 within_current_scope = 0;
3747 }
3748
3749 if (within_current_scope)
3750 /* If we end up stopping, the current frame will get selected
3751 in normal_stop. So this call to select_frame won't affect
3752 the user. */
3753 select_frame (fr);
3754 }
3755
3756 if (within_current_scope)
3757 {
3758 /* We use value_{,free_to_}mark because it could be a *long*
3759 time before we return to the command level and call
3760 free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values because we
3761 might be in the middle of evaluating a function call. */
3762
3763 int pc = 0;
3764 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
3765 struct value *new_val;
3766
3767 fetch_subexp_value (b->exp, &pc, &new_val, NULL, NULL);
3768
3769 /* We use value_equal_contents instead of value_equal because
3770 the latter coerces an array to a pointer, thus comparing just
3771 the address of the array instead of its contents. This is
3772 not what we want. */
3773 if ((b->val != NULL) != (new_val != NULL)
3774 || (b->val != NULL && !value_equal_contents (b->val, new_val)))
3775 {
3776 if (new_val != NULL)
3777 {
3778 release_value (new_val);
3779 value_free_to_mark (mark);
3780 }
3781 bs->old_val = b->val;
3782 b->val = new_val;
3783 b->val_valid = 1;
3784 return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
3785 }
3786 else
3787 {
3788 /* Nothing changed. */
3789 value_free_to_mark (mark);
3790 return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED;
3791 }
3792 }
3793 else
3794 {
3795 /* This seems like the only logical thing to do because
3796 if we temporarily ignored the watchpoint, then when
3797 we reenter the block in which it is valid it contains
3798 garbage (in the case of a function, it may have two
3799 garbage values, one before and one after the prologue).
3800 So we can't even detect the first assignment to it and
3801 watch after that (since the garbage may or may not equal
3802 the first value assigned). */
3803 /* We print all the stop information in print_it_typical(), but
3804 in this case, by the time we call print_it_typical() this bp
3805 will be deleted already. So we have no choice but print the
3806 information here. */
3807 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3808 ui_out_field_string
3809 (uiout, "reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_SCOPE));
3810 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nWatchpoint ");
3811 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "wpnum", b->number);
3812 ui_out_text (uiout,
3813 " deleted because the program has left the block in\n\
3814 which its expression is valid.\n");
3815
3816 if (b->related_breakpoint)
3817 {
3818 b->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3819 b->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = NULL;
3820 b->related_breakpoint = NULL;
3821 }
3822 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3823
3824 return WP_DELETED;
3825 }
3826 }
3827
3828 /* Return true if it looks like target has stopped due to hitting
3829 breakpoint location BL. This function does not check if we
3830 should stop, only if BL explains the stop. */
3831 static int
3832 bpstat_check_location (const struct bp_location *bl,
3833 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr)
3834 {
3835 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
3836
3837 /* BL is from existing struct breakpoint. */
3838 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
3839
3840 /* By definition, the inferior does not report stops at
3841 tracepoints. */
3842 if (is_tracepoint (b))
3843 return 0;
3844
3845 if (!is_watchpoint (b)
3846 && b->type != bp_hardware_breakpoint
3847 && b->type != bp_catchpoint) /* a non-watchpoint bp */
3848 {
3849 if (!breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
3850 aspace, bp_addr))
3851 return 0;
3852 if (overlay_debugging /* unmapped overlay section */
3853 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
3854 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3855 return 0;
3856 }
3857
3858 /* Continuable hardware watchpoints are treated as non-existent if the
3859 reason we stopped wasn't a hardware watchpoint (we didn't stop on
3860 some data address). Otherwise gdb won't stop on a break instruction
3861 in the code (not from a breakpoint) when a hardware watchpoint has
3862 been defined. Also skip watchpoints which we know did not trigger
3863 (did not match the data address). */
3864
3865 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
3866 && b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_no)
3867 return 0;
3868
3869 if (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
3870 {
3871 if (bl->address != bp_addr)
3872 return 0;
3873 if (overlay_debugging /* unmapped overlay section */
3874 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
3875 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3876 return 0;
3877 }
3878
3879 if (b->type == bp_catchpoint)
3880 {
3881 gdb_assert (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->breakpoint_hit != NULL);
3882 if (!b->ops->breakpoint_hit (b))
3883 return 0;
3884 }
3885
3886 return 1;
3887 }
3888
3889 /* If BS refers to a watchpoint, determine if the watched values
3890 has actually changed, and we should stop. If not, set BS->stop
3891 to 0. */
3892 static void
3893 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
3894 {
3895 const struct bp_location *bl;
3896 struct breakpoint *b;
3897
3898 /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */
3899 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
3900 gdb_assert (bl != NULL);
3901 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
3902 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
3903
3904 if (is_watchpoint (b))
3905 {
3906 int must_check_value = 0;
3907
3908 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint)
3909 /* For a software watchpoint, we must always check the
3910 watched value. */
3911 must_check_value = 1;
3912 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_yes)
3913 /* We have a hardware watchpoint (read, write, or access)
3914 and the target earlier reported an address watched by
3915 this watchpoint. */
3916 must_check_value = 1;
3917 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_unknown
3918 && b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
3919 /* We were stopped by a hardware watchpoint, but the target could
3920 not report the data address. We must check the watchpoint's
3921 value. Access and read watchpoints are out of luck; without
3922 a data address, we can't figure it out. */
3923 must_check_value = 1;
3924
3925 if (must_check_value)
3926 {
3927 char *message
3928 = xstrprintf ("Error evaluating expression for watchpoint %d\n",
3929 b->number);
3930 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, message);
3931 int e = catch_errors (watchpoint_check, bs, message,
3932 RETURN_MASK_ALL);
3933 do_cleanups (cleanups);
3934 switch (e)
3935 {
3936 case WP_DELETED:
3937 /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
3938 bs->print_it = print_it_done;
3939 /* Stop. */
3940 break;
3941 case WP_IGNORE:
3942 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3943 bs->stop = 0;
3944 break;
3945 case WP_VALUE_CHANGED:
3946 if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
3947 {
3948 /* There are two cases to consider here:
3949
3950 1. We're watching the triggered memory for reads.
3951 In that case, trust the target, and always report
3952 the watchpoint hit to the user. Even though
3953 reads don't cause value changes, the value may
3954 have changed since the last time it was read, and
3955 since we're not trapping writes, we will not see
3956 those, and as such we should ignore our notion of
3957 old value.
3958
3959 2. We're watching the triggered memory for both
3960 reads and writes. There are two ways this may
3961 happen:
3962
3963 2.1. This is a target that can't break on data
3964 reads only, but can break on accesses (reads or
3965 writes), such as e.g., x86. We detect this case
3966 at the time we try to insert read watchpoints.
3967
3968 2.2. Otherwise, the target supports read
3969 watchpoints, but, the user set an access or write
3970 watchpoint watching the same memory as this read
3971 watchpoint.
3972
3973 If we're watching memory writes as well as reads,
3974 ignore watchpoint hits when we find that the
3975 value hasn't changed, as reads don't cause
3976 changes. This still gives false positives when
3977 the program writes the same value to memory as
3978 what there was already in memory (we will confuse
3979 it for a read), but it's much better than
3980 nothing. */
3981
3982 int other_write_watchpoint = 0;
3983
3984 if (bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
3985 {
3986 struct breakpoint *other_b;
3987
3988 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (other_b)
3989 if ((other_b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3990 || other_b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
3991 && (other_b->watchpoint_triggered
3992 == watch_triggered_yes))
3993 {
3994 other_write_watchpoint = 1;
3995 break;
3996 }
3997 }
3998
3999 if (other_write_watchpoint
4000 || bl->watchpoint_type == hw_access)
4001 {
4002 /* We're watching the same memory for writes,
4003 and the value changed since the last time we
4004 updated it, so this trap must be for a write.
4005 Ignore it. */
4006 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
4007 bs->stop = 0;
4008 }
4009 }
4010 break;
4011 case WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED:
4012 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
4013 || b->type == bp_watchpoint)
4014 {
4015 /* Don't stop: write watchpoints shouldn't fire if
4016 the value hasn't changed. */
4017 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
4018 bs->stop = 0;
4019 }
4020 /* Stop. */
4021 break;
4022 default:
4023 /* Can't happen. */
4024 case 0:
4025 /* Error from catch_errors. */
4026 printf_filtered (_("Watchpoint %d deleted.\n"), b->number);
4027 if (b->related_breakpoint)
4028 b->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
4029 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
4030 /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
4031 bs->print_it = print_it_done;
4032 break;
4033 }
4034 }
4035 else /* must_check_value == 0 */
4036 {
4037 /* This is a case where some watchpoint(s) triggered, but
4038 not at the address of this watchpoint, or else no
4039 watchpoint triggered after all. So don't print
4040 anything for this watchpoint. */
4041 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
4042 bs->stop = 0;
4043 }
4044 }
4045 }
4046
4047
4048 /* Check conditions (condition proper, frame, thread and ignore count)
4049 of breakpoint referred to by BS. If we should not stop for this
4050 breakpoint, set BS->stop to 0. */
4051
4052 static void
4053 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bpstat bs, ptid_t ptid)
4054 {
4055 int thread_id = pid_to_thread_id (ptid);
4056 const struct bp_location *bl;
4057 struct breakpoint *b;
4058
4059 /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */
4060 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
4061 gdb_assert (bl != NULL);
4062 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
4063 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
4064
4065 if (frame_id_p (b->frame_id)
4066 && !frame_id_eq (b->frame_id, get_stack_frame_id (get_current_frame ())))
4067 bs->stop = 0;
4068 else if (bs->stop)
4069 {
4070 int value_is_zero = 0;
4071 struct expression *cond;
4072
4073 if (is_watchpoint (b))
4074 cond = b->cond_exp;
4075 else
4076 cond = bl->cond;
4077
4078 if (cond && b->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
4079 {
4080 int within_current_scope = 1;
4081
4082 /* We use value_mark and value_free_to_mark because it could
4083 be a long time before we return to the command level and
4084 call free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values
4085 because we might be in the middle of evaluating a
4086 function call. */
4087 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
4088
4089 /* Need to select the frame, with all that implies so that
4090 the conditions will have the right context. Because we
4091 use the frame, we will not see an inlined function's
4092 variables when we arrive at a breakpoint at the start
4093 of the inlined function; the current frame will be the
4094 call site. */
4095 if (!is_watchpoint (b) || b->cond_exp_valid_block == NULL)
4096 select_frame (get_current_frame ());
4097 else
4098 {
4099 struct frame_info *frame;
4100
4101 /* For local watchpoint expressions, which particular
4102 instance of a local is being watched matters, so we
4103 keep track of the frame to evaluate the expression
4104 in. To evaluate the condition however, it doesn't
4105 really matter which instantiation of the function
4106 where the condition makes sense triggers the
4107 watchpoint. This allows an expression like "watch
4108 global if q > 10" set in `func', catch writes to
4109 global on all threads that call `func', or catch
4110 writes on all recursive calls of `func' by a single
4111 thread. We simply always evaluate the condition in
4112 the innermost frame that's executing where it makes
4113 sense to evaluate the condition. It seems
4114 intuitive. */
4115 frame = block_innermost_frame (b->cond_exp_valid_block);
4116 if (frame != NULL)
4117 select_frame (frame);
4118 else
4119 within_current_scope = 0;
4120 }
4121 if (within_current_scope)
4122 value_is_zero
4123 = catch_errors (breakpoint_cond_eval, cond,
4124 "Error in testing breakpoint condition:\n",
4125 RETURN_MASK_ALL);
4126 else
4127 {
4128 warning (_("Watchpoint condition cannot be tested "
4129 "in the current scope"));
4130 /* If we failed to set the right context for this
4131 watchpoint, unconditionally report it. */
4132 value_is_zero = 0;
4133 }
4134 /* FIXME-someday, should give breakpoint #. */
4135 value_free_to_mark (mark);
4136 }
4137
4138 if (cond && value_is_zero)
4139 {
4140 bs->stop = 0;
4141 }
4142 else if (b->thread != -1 && b->thread != thread_id)
4143 {
4144 bs->stop = 0;
4145 }
4146 else if (b->ignore_count > 0)
4147 {
4148 b->ignore_count--;
4149 annotate_ignore_count_change ();
4150 bs->stop = 0;
4151 /* Increase the hit count even though we don't stop. */
4152 ++(b->hit_count);
4153 }
4154 }
4155 }
4156
4157
4158 /* Get a bpstat associated with having just stopped at address
4159 BP_ADDR in thread PTID.
4160
4161 Determine whether we stopped at a breakpoint, etc, or whether we
4162 don't understand this stop. Result is a chain of bpstat's such
4163 that:
4164
4165 if we don't understand the stop, the result is a null pointer.
4166
4167 if we understand why we stopped, the result is not null.
4168
4169 Each element of the chain refers to a particular breakpoint or
4170 watchpoint at which we have stopped. (We may have stopped for
4171 several reasons concurrently.)
4172
4173 Each element of the chain has valid next, breakpoint_at,
4174 commands, FIXME??? fields. */
4175
4176 bpstat
4177 bpstat_stop_status (struct address_space *aspace,
4178 CORE_ADDR bp_addr, ptid_t ptid)
4179 {
4180 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
4181 struct bp_location *bl;
4182 struct bp_location *loc;
4183 /* First item of allocated bpstat's. */
4184 bpstat bs_head = NULL, *bs_link = &bs_head;
4185 /* Pointer to the last thing in the chain currently. */
4186 bpstat bs;
4187 int ix;
4188 int need_remove_insert;
4189 int removed_any;
4190
4191 /* First, build the bpstat chain with locations that explain a
4192 target stop, while being careful to not set the target running,
4193 as that may invalidate locations (in particular watchpoint
4194 locations are recreated). Resuming will happen here with
4195 breakpoint conditions or watchpoint expressions that include
4196 inferior function calls. */
4197
4198 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4199 {
4200 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b) && b->enable_state != bp_permanent)
4201 continue;
4202
4203 for (bl = b->loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next)
4204 {
4205 /* For hardware watchpoints, we look only at the first
4206 location. The watchpoint_check function will work on the
4207 entire expression, not the individual locations. For
4208 read watchpoints, the watchpoints_triggered function has
4209 checked all locations already. */
4210 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint && bl != b->loc)
4211 break;
4212
4213 if (bl->shlib_disabled)
4214 continue;
4215
4216 if (!bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, bp_addr))
4217 continue;
4218
4219 /* Come here if it's a watchpoint, or if the break address
4220 matches. */
4221
4222 bs = bpstat_alloc (bl, &bs_link); /* Alloc a bpstat to
4223 explain stop. */
4224
4225 /* Assume we stop. Should we find a watchpoint that is not
4226 actually triggered, or if the condition of the breakpoint
4227 evaluates as false, we'll reset 'stop' to 0. */
4228 bs->stop = 1;
4229 bs->print = 1;
4230
4231 /* If this is a scope breakpoint, mark the associated
4232 watchpoint as triggered so that we will handle the
4233 out-of-scope event. We'll get to the watchpoint next
4234 iteration. */
4235 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
4236 b->related_breakpoint->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
4237 }
4238 }
4239
4240 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
4241 {
4242 if (breakpoint_address_match (loc->pspace->aspace, loc->address,
4243 aspace, bp_addr))
4244 {
4245 bs = bpstat_alloc (loc, &bs_link);
4246 /* For hits of moribund locations, we should just proceed. */
4247 bs->stop = 0;
4248 bs->print = 0;
4249 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
4250 }
4251 }
4252
4253 /* Now go through the locations that caused the target to stop, and
4254 check whether we're interested in reporting this stop to higher
4255 layers, or whether we should resume the target transparently. */
4256
4257 removed_any = 0;
4258
4259 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4260 {
4261 if (!bs->stop)
4262 continue;
4263
4264 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bs);
4265 if (!bs->stop)
4266 continue;
4267
4268 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
4269
4270 if (b->type == bp_thread_event || b->type == bp_overlay_event
4271 || b->type == bp_longjmp_master
4272 || b->type == bp_std_terminate_master
4273 || b->type == bp_exception_master)
4274 /* We do not stop for these. */
4275 bs->stop = 0;
4276 else
4277 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bs, ptid);
4278
4279 if (bs->stop)
4280 {
4281 ++(b->hit_count);
4282
4283 /* We will stop here. */
4284 if (b->disposition == disp_disable)
4285 {
4286 if (b->enable_state != bp_permanent)
4287 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
4288 removed_any = 1;
4289 }
4290 if (b->silent)
4291 bs->print = 0;
4292 bs->commands = b->commands;
4293 incref_counted_command_line (bs->commands);
4294 bs->commands_left = bs->commands ? bs->commands->commands : NULL;
4295 if (bs->commands_left
4296 && (strcmp ("silent", bs->commands_left->line) == 0
4297 || (xdb_commands
4298 && strcmp ("Q",
4299 bs->commands_left->line) == 0)))
4300 {
4301 bs->commands_left = bs->commands_left->next;
4302 bs->print = 0;
4303 }
4304 }
4305
4306 /* Print nothing for this entry if we dont stop or dont print. */
4307 if (bs->stop == 0 || bs->print == 0)
4308 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
4309 }
4310
4311 /* If we aren't stopping, the value of some hardware watchpoint may
4312 not have changed, but the intermediate memory locations we are
4313 watching may have. Don't bother if we're stopping; this will get
4314 done later. */
4315 need_remove_insert = 0;
4316 if (! bpstat_causes_stop (bs_head))
4317 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4318 if (!bs->stop
4319 && bs->breakpoint_at
4320 && is_hardware_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at))
4321 {
4322 update_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
4323 need_remove_insert = 1;
4324 }
4325
4326 if (need_remove_insert)
4327 update_global_location_list (1);
4328 else if (removed_any)
4329 update_global_location_list (0);
4330
4331 return bs_head;
4332 }
4333
4334 static void
4335 handle_jit_event (void)
4336 {
4337 struct frame_info *frame;
4338 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
4339
4340 /* Switch terminal for any messages produced by
4341 breakpoint_re_set. */
4342 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
4343
4344 frame = get_current_frame ();
4345 gdbarch = get_frame_arch (frame);
4346
4347 jit_event_handler (gdbarch);
4348
4349 target_terminal_inferior ();
4350 }
4351
4352 /* Prepare WHAT final decision for infrun. */
4353
4354 /* Decide what infrun needs to do with this bpstat. */
4355
4356 struct bpstat_what
4357 bpstat_what (bpstat bs)
4358 {
4359 struct bpstat_what retval;
4360 /* We need to defer calling `solib_add', as adding new symbols
4361 resets breakpoints, which in turn deletes breakpoint locations,
4362 and hence may clear unprocessed entries in the BS chain. */
4363 int shlib_event = 0;
4364 int jit_event = 0;
4365
4366 retval.main_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
4367 retval.call_dummy = STOP_NONE;
4368 retval.is_longjmp = 0;
4369
4370 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4371 {
4372 /* Extract this BS's action. After processing each BS, we check
4373 if its action overrides all we've seem so far. */
4374 enum bpstat_what_main_action this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
4375 enum bptype bptype;
4376
4377 if (bs->breakpoint_at == NULL)
4378 {
4379 /* I suspect this can happen if it was a momentary
4380 breakpoint which has since been deleted. */
4381 bptype = bp_none;
4382 }
4383 else if (bs->breakpoint_at == NULL)
4384 bptype = bp_none;
4385 else
4386 bptype = bs->breakpoint_at->type;
4387
4388 switch (bptype)
4389 {
4390 case bp_none:
4391 break;
4392 case bp_breakpoint:
4393 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
4394 case bp_until:
4395 case bp_finish:
4396 if (bs->stop)
4397 {
4398 if (bs->print)
4399 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
4400 else
4401 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
4402 }
4403 else
4404 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
4405 break;
4406 case bp_watchpoint:
4407 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
4408 case bp_read_watchpoint:
4409 case bp_access_watchpoint:
4410 if (bs->stop)
4411 {
4412 if (bs->print)
4413 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
4414 else
4415 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
4416 }
4417 else
4418 {
4419 /* There was a watchpoint, but we're not stopping.
4420 This requires no further action. */
4421 }
4422 break;
4423 case bp_longjmp:
4424 case bp_exception:
4425 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SET_LONGJMP_RESUME;
4426 retval.is_longjmp = bptype == bp_longjmp;
4427 break;
4428 case bp_longjmp_resume:
4429 case bp_exception_resume:
4430 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_CLEAR_LONGJMP_RESUME;
4431 retval.is_longjmp = bptype == bp_longjmp_resume;
4432 break;
4433 case bp_step_resume:
4434 if (bs->stop)
4435 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STEP_RESUME;
4436 else
4437 {
4438 /* It is for the wrong frame. */
4439 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
4440 }
4441 break;
4442 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
4443 case bp_thread_event:
4444 case bp_overlay_event:
4445 case bp_longjmp_master:
4446 case bp_std_terminate_master:
4447 case bp_exception_master:
4448 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
4449 break;
4450 case bp_catchpoint:
4451 if (bs->stop)
4452 {
4453 if (bs->print)
4454 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
4455 else
4456 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
4457 }
4458 else
4459 {
4460 /* There was a catchpoint, but we're not stopping.
4461 This requires no further action. */
4462 }
4463 break;
4464 case bp_shlib_event:
4465 shlib_event = 1;
4466
4467 /* If requested, stop when the dynamic linker notifies GDB
4468 of events. This allows the user to get control and place
4469 breakpoints in initializer routines for dynamically
4470 loaded objects (among other things). */
4471 if (stop_on_solib_events)
4472 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
4473 else
4474 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
4475 break;
4476 case bp_jit_event:
4477 jit_event = 1;
4478 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
4479 break;
4480 case bp_call_dummy:
4481 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
4482 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
4483 retval.call_dummy = STOP_STACK_DUMMY;
4484 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
4485 break;
4486 case bp_std_terminate:
4487 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
4488 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
4489 retval.call_dummy = STOP_STD_TERMINATE;
4490 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
4491 break;
4492 case bp_tracepoint:
4493 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
4494 case bp_static_tracepoint:
4495 /* Tracepoint hits should not be reported back to GDB, and
4496 if one got through somehow, it should have been filtered
4497 out already. */
4498 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4499 _("bpstat_what: tracepoint encountered"));
4500 default:
4501 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4502 _("bpstat_what: unhandled bptype %d"), (int) bptype);
4503 }
4504
4505 retval.main_action = max (retval.main_action, this_action);
4506 }
4507
4508 if (shlib_event)
4509 {
4510 if (debug_infrun)
4511 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stdlog, "bpstat_what: bp_shlib_event\n");
4512
4513 /* Check for any newly added shared libraries if we're supposed
4514 to be adding them automatically. */
4515
4516 /* Switch terminal for any messages produced by
4517 breakpoint_re_set. */
4518 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
4519
4520 #ifdef SOLIB_ADD
4521 SOLIB_ADD (NULL, 0, &current_target, auto_solib_add);
4522 #else
4523 solib_add (NULL, 0, &current_target, auto_solib_add);
4524 #endif
4525
4526 target_terminal_inferior ();
4527 }
4528
4529 if (jit_event)
4530 {
4531 if (debug_infrun)
4532 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stdlog, "bpstat_what: bp_jit_event\n");
4533
4534 handle_jit_event ();
4535 }
4536
4537 return retval;
4538 }
4539
4540 /* Nonzero if we should step constantly (e.g. watchpoints on machines
4541 without hardware support). This isn't related to a specific bpstat,
4542 just to things like whether watchpoints are set. */
4543
4544 int
4545 bpstat_should_step (void)
4546 {
4547 struct breakpoint *b;
4548
4549 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4550 if (breakpoint_enabled (b) && b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc != NULL)
4551 return 1;
4552 return 0;
4553 }
4554
4555 int
4556 bpstat_causes_stop (bpstat bs)
4557 {
4558 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4559 if (bs->stop)
4560 return 1;
4561
4562 return 0;
4563 }
4564
4565 \f
4566
4567 /* Compute a string of spaces suitable to indent the next line
4568 so it starts at the position corresponding to the table column
4569 named COL_NAME in the currently active table of UIOUT. */
4570
4571 static char *
4572 wrap_indent_at_field (struct ui_out *uiout, const char *col_name)
4573 {
4574 static char wrap_indent[80];
4575 int i, total_width, width, align;
4576 char *text;
4577
4578 total_width = 0;
4579 for (i = 1; ui_out_query_field (uiout, i, &width, &align, &text); i++)
4580 {
4581 if (strcmp (text, col_name) == 0)
4582 {
4583 gdb_assert (total_width < sizeof wrap_indent);
4584 memset (wrap_indent, ' ', total_width);
4585 wrap_indent[total_width] = 0;
4586
4587 return wrap_indent;
4588 }
4589
4590 total_width += width + 1;
4591 }
4592
4593 return NULL;
4594 }
4595
4596 /* Print the LOC location out of the list of B->LOC locations. */
4597
4598 static void
4599 print_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
4600 struct bp_location *loc)
4601 {
4602 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
4603
4604 if (loc != NULL && loc->shlib_disabled)
4605 loc = NULL;
4606
4607 if (loc != NULL)
4608 set_current_program_space (loc->pspace);
4609
4610 if (b->source_file && loc)
4611 {
4612 struct symbol *sym
4613 = find_pc_sect_function (loc->address, loc->section);
4614 if (sym)
4615 {
4616 ui_out_text (uiout, "in ");
4617 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "func",
4618 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym));
4619 ui_out_text (uiout, " ");
4620 ui_out_wrap_hint (uiout, wrap_indent_at_field (uiout, "what"));
4621 ui_out_text (uiout, "at ");
4622 }
4623 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "file", b->source_file);
4624 ui_out_text (uiout, ":");
4625
4626 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
4627 {
4628 struct symtab_and_line sal = find_pc_line (loc->address, 0);
4629 char *fullname = symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab);
4630
4631 if (fullname)
4632 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "fullname", fullname);
4633 }
4634
4635 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "line", b->line_number);
4636 }
4637 else if (loc)
4638 {
4639 struct ui_stream *stb = ui_out_stream_new (uiout);
4640 struct cleanup *stb_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_stream_delete (stb);
4641
4642 print_address_symbolic (loc->gdbarch, loc->address, stb->stream,
4643 demangle, "");
4644 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "at", stb);
4645
4646 do_cleanups (stb_chain);
4647 }
4648 else
4649 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "pending", b->addr_string);
4650
4651 do_cleanups (old_chain);
4652 }
4653
4654 static const char *
4655 bptype_string (enum bptype type)
4656 {
4657 struct ep_type_description
4658 {
4659 enum bptype type;
4660 char *description;
4661 };
4662 static struct ep_type_description bptypes[] =
4663 {
4664 {bp_none, "?deleted?"},
4665 {bp_breakpoint, "breakpoint"},
4666 {bp_hardware_breakpoint, "hw breakpoint"},
4667 {bp_until, "until"},
4668 {bp_finish, "finish"},
4669 {bp_watchpoint, "watchpoint"},
4670 {bp_hardware_watchpoint, "hw watchpoint"},
4671 {bp_read_watchpoint, "read watchpoint"},
4672 {bp_access_watchpoint, "acc watchpoint"},
4673 {bp_longjmp, "longjmp"},
4674 {bp_longjmp_resume, "longjmp resume"},
4675 {bp_exception, "exception"},
4676 {bp_exception_resume, "exception resume"},
4677 {bp_step_resume, "step resume"},
4678 {bp_watchpoint_scope, "watchpoint scope"},
4679 {bp_call_dummy, "call dummy"},
4680 {bp_std_terminate, "std::terminate"},
4681 {bp_shlib_event, "shlib events"},
4682 {bp_thread_event, "thread events"},
4683 {bp_overlay_event, "overlay events"},
4684 {bp_longjmp_master, "longjmp master"},
4685 {bp_std_terminate_master, "std::terminate master"},
4686 {bp_exception_master, "exception master"},
4687 {bp_catchpoint, "catchpoint"},
4688 {bp_tracepoint, "tracepoint"},
4689 {bp_fast_tracepoint, "fast tracepoint"},
4690 {bp_static_tracepoint, "static tracepoint"},
4691 {bp_jit_event, "jit events"},
4692 };
4693
4694 if (((int) type >= (sizeof (bptypes) / sizeof (bptypes[0])))
4695 || ((int) type != bptypes[(int) type].type))
4696 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4697 _("bptypes table does not describe type #%d."),
4698 (int) type);
4699
4700 return bptypes[(int) type].description;
4701 }
4702
4703 /* Print B to gdb_stdout. */
4704
4705 static void
4706 print_one_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
4707 struct bp_location *loc,
4708 int loc_number,
4709 struct bp_location **last_loc,
4710 int allflag)
4711 {
4712 struct command_line *l;
4713 static char bpenables[] = "nynny";
4714 struct cleanup *bkpt_chain;
4715
4716 int header_of_multiple = 0;
4717 int part_of_multiple = (loc != NULL);
4718 struct value_print_options opts;
4719
4720 get_user_print_options (&opts);
4721
4722 gdb_assert (!loc || loc_number != 0);
4723 /* See comment in print_one_breakpoint concerning treatment of
4724 breakpoints with single disabled location. */
4725 if (loc == NULL
4726 && (b->loc != NULL
4727 && (b->loc->next != NULL || !b->loc->enabled)))
4728 header_of_multiple = 1;
4729 if (loc == NULL)
4730 loc = b->loc;
4731
4732 annotate_record ();
4733 bkpt_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "bkpt");
4734
4735 /* 1 */
4736 annotate_field (0);
4737 if (part_of_multiple)
4738 {
4739 char *formatted;
4740 formatted = xstrprintf ("%d.%d", b->number, loc_number);
4741 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "number", formatted);
4742 xfree (formatted);
4743 }
4744 else
4745 {
4746 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
4747 }
4748
4749 /* 2 */
4750 annotate_field (1);
4751 if (part_of_multiple)
4752 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "type");
4753 else
4754 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "type", bptype_string (b->type));
4755
4756 /* 3 */
4757 annotate_field (2);
4758 if (part_of_multiple)
4759 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "disp");
4760 else
4761 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
4762
4763
4764 /* 4 */
4765 annotate_field (3);
4766 if (part_of_multiple)
4767 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "enabled", loc->enabled ? "y" : "n");
4768 else
4769 ui_out_field_fmt (uiout, "enabled", "%c",
4770 bpenables[(int) b->enable_state]);
4771 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 2);
4772
4773
4774 /* 5 and 6 */
4775 if (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_one != NULL)
4776 {
4777 /* Although the print_one can possibly print all locations,
4778 calling it here is not likely to get any nice result. So,
4779 make sure there's just one location. */
4780 gdb_assert (b->loc == NULL || b->loc->next == NULL);
4781 b->ops->print_one (b, last_loc);
4782 }
4783 else
4784 switch (b->type)
4785 {
4786 case bp_none:
4787 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4788 _("print_one_breakpoint: bp_none encountered\n"));
4789 break;
4790
4791 case bp_watchpoint:
4792 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
4793 case bp_read_watchpoint:
4794 case bp_access_watchpoint:
4795 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
4796 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
4797 is relatively readable). */
4798 if (opts.addressprint)
4799 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
4800 annotate_field (5);
4801 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", b->exp_string);
4802 break;
4803
4804 case bp_breakpoint:
4805 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
4806 case bp_until:
4807 case bp_finish:
4808 case bp_longjmp:
4809 case bp_longjmp_resume:
4810 case bp_exception:
4811 case bp_exception_resume:
4812 case bp_step_resume:
4813 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
4814 case bp_call_dummy:
4815 case bp_std_terminate:
4816 case bp_shlib_event:
4817 case bp_thread_event:
4818 case bp_overlay_event:
4819 case bp_longjmp_master:
4820 case bp_std_terminate_master:
4821 case bp_exception_master:
4822 case bp_tracepoint:
4823 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
4824 case bp_static_tracepoint:
4825 case bp_jit_event:
4826 if (opts.addressprint)
4827 {
4828 annotate_field (4);
4829 if (header_of_multiple)
4830 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<MULTIPLE>");
4831 else if (b->loc == NULL || loc->shlib_disabled)
4832 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<PENDING>");
4833 else
4834 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "addr",
4835 loc->gdbarch, loc->address);
4836 }
4837 annotate_field (5);
4838 if (!header_of_multiple)
4839 print_breakpoint_location (b, loc);
4840 if (b->loc)
4841 *last_loc = b->loc;
4842 break;
4843 }
4844
4845
4846 /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors unless there
4847 are several. */
4848 if (loc != NULL
4849 && !header_of_multiple
4850 && (allflag
4851 || (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch)
4852 && (number_of_program_spaces () > 1
4853 || number_of_inferiors () > 1)
4854 /* LOC is for existing B, it cannot be in
4855 moribund_locations and thus having NULL OWNER. */
4856 && loc->owner->type != bp_catchpoint)))
4857 {
4858 struct inferior *inf;
4859 int first = 1;
4860
4861 for (inf = inferior_list; inf != NULL; inf = inf->next)
4862 {
4863 if (inf->pspace == loc->pspace)
4864 {
4865 if (first)
4866 {
4867 first = 0;
4868 ui_out_text (uiout, " inf ");
4869 }
4870 else
4871 ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
4872 ui_out_text (uiout, plongest (inf->num));
4873 }
4874 }
4875 }
4876
4877 if (!part_of_multiple)
4878 {
4879 if (b->thread != -1)
4880 {
4881 /* FIXME: This seems to be redundant and lost here; see the
4882 "stop only in" line a little further down. */
4883 ui_out_text (uiout, " thread ");
4884 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "thread", b->thread);
4885 }
4886 else if (b->task != 0)
4887 {
4888 ui_out_text (uiout, " task ");
4889 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "task", b->task);
4890 }
4891 }
4892
4893 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4894
4895 if (!part_of_multiple && b->static_trace_marker_id)
4896 {
4897 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint);
4898
4899 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tmarker id is ");
4900 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "static-tracepoint-marker-string-id",
4901 b->static_trace_marker_id);
4902 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4903 }
4904
4905 if (part_of_multiple && frame_id_p (b->frame_id))
4906 {
4907 annotate_field (6);
4908 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only in stack frame at ");
4909 /* FIXME: cagney/2002-12-01: Shouldn't be poeking around inside
4910 the frame ID. */
4911 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "frame",
4912 b->gdbarch, b->frame_id.stack_addr);
4913 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4914 }
4915
4916 if (!part_of_multiple && b->cond_string && !ada_exception_catchpoint_p (b))
4917 {
4918 /* We do not print the condition for Ada exception catchpoints
4919 because the condition is an internal implementation detail
4920 that we do not want to expose to the user. */
4921 annotate_field (7);
4922 if (is_tracepoint (b))
4923 ui_out_text (uiout, "\ttrace only if ");
4924 else
4925 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only if ");
4926 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "cond", b->cond_string);
4927 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4928 }
4929
4930 if (!part_of_multiple && b->thread != -1)
4931 {
4932 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this. */
4933 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only in thread ");
4934 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "thread", b->thread);
4935 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4936 }
4937
4938 if (!part_of_multiple && b->hit_count)
4939 {
4940 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this. */
4941 if (ep_is_catchpoint (b))
4942 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tcatchpoint");
4943 else
4944 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tbreakpoint");
4945 ui_out_text (uiout, " already hit ");
4946 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "times", b->hit_count);
4947 if (b->hit_count == 1)
4948 ui_out_text (uiout, " time\n");
4949 else
4950 ui_out_text (uiout, " times\n");
4951 }
4952
4953 /* Output the count also if it is zero, but only if this is mi.
4954 FIXME: Should have a better test for this. */
4955 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
4956 if (!part_of_multiple && b->hit_count == 0)
4957 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "times", b->hit_count);
4958
4959 if (!part_of_multiple && b->ignore_count)
4960 {
4961 annotate_field (8);
4962 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tignore next ");
4963 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "ignore", b->ignore_count);
4964 ui_out_text (uiout, " hits\n");
4965 }
4966
4967 l = b->commands ? b->commands->commands : NULL;
4968 if (!part_of_multiple && l)
4969 {
4970 struct cleanup *script_chain;
4971
4972 annotate_field (9);
4973 script_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "script");
4974 print_command_lines (uiout, l, 4);
4975 do_cleanups (script_chain);
4976 }
4977
4978 if (!part_of_multiple && b->pass_count)
4979 {
4980 annotate_field (10);
4981 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tpass count ");
4982 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "pass", b->pass_count);
4983 ui_out_text (uiout, " \n");
4984 }
4985
4986 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout) && !part_of_multiple)
4987 {
4988 if (b->addr_string)
4989 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "original-location", b->addr_string);
4990 else if (b->exp_string)
4991 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "original-location", b->exp_string);
4992 }
4993
4994 do_cleanups (bkpt_chain);
4995 }
4996
4997 static void
4998 print_one_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
4999 struct bp_location **last_loc,
5000 int allflag)
5001 {
5002 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, NULL, 0, last_loc, allflag);
5003
5004 /* If this breakpoint has custom print function,
5005 it's already printed. Otherwise, print individual
5006 locations, if any. */
5007 if (b->ops == NULL || b->ops->print_one == NULL)
5008 {
5009 /* If breakpoint has a single location that is disabled, we
5010 print it as if it had several locations, since otherwise it's
5011 hard to represent "breakpoint enabled, location disabled"
5012 situation.
5013
5014 Note that while hardware watchpoints have several locations
5015 internally, that's not a property exposed to user. */
5016 if (b->loc
5017 && !is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
5018 && (b->loc->next || !b->loc->enabled)
5019 && !ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
5020 {
5021 struct bp_location *loc;
5022 int n = 1;
5023 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next, ++n)
5024 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, loc, n, last_loc, allflag);
5025 }
5026 }
5027 }
5028
5029 static int
5030 breakpoint_address_bits (struct breakpoint *b)
5031 {
5032 int print_address_bits = 0;
5033 struct bp_location *loc;
5034
5035 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
5036 {
5037 int addr_bit;
5038
5039 /* Software watchpoints that aren't watching memory don't have
5040 an address to print. */
5041 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && loc->watchpoint_type == -1)
5042 continue;
5043
5044 addr_bit = gdbarch_addr_bit (loc->gdbarch);
5045 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
5046 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
5047 }
5048
5049 return print_address_bits;
5050 }
5051
5052 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args
5053 {
5054 int bnum;
5055 };
5056
5057 static int
5058 do_captured_breakpoint_query (struct ui_out *uiout, void *data)
5059 {
5060 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args *args = data;
5061 struct breakpoint *b;
5062 struct bp_location *dummy_loc = NULL;
5063
5064 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5065 {
5066 if (args->bnum == b->number)
5067 {
5068 print_one_breakpoint (b, &dummy_loc, 0);
5069 return GDB_RC_OK;
5070 }
5071 }
5072 return GDB_RC_NONE;
5073 }
5074
5075 enum gdb_rc
5076 gdb_breakpoint_query (struct ui_out *uiout, int bnum,
5077 char **error_message)
5078 {
5079 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args args;
5080
5081 args.bnum = bnum;
5082 /* For the moment we don't trust print_one_breakpoint() to not throw
5083 an error. */
5084 if (catch_exceptions_with_msg (uiout, do_captured_breakpoint_query, &args,
5085 error_message, RETURN_MASK_ALL) < 0)
5086 return GDB_RC_FAIL;
5087 else
5088 return GDB_RC_OK;
5089 }
5090
5091 /* Return non-zero if B is user settable (breakpoints, watchpoints,
5092 catchpoints, et.al.). */
5093
5094 static int
5095 user_settable_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
5096 {
5097 return (b->type == bp_breakpoint
5098 || b->type == bp_catchpoint
5099 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
5100 || is_tracepoint (b)
5101 || is_watchpoint (b));
5102 }
5103
5104 /* Return true if this breakpoint was set by the user, false if it is
5105 internal or momentary. */
5106
5107 int
5108 user_breakpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
5109 {
5110 return user_settable_breakpoint (b) && b->number > 0;
5111 }
5112
5113 /* Print information on user settable breakpoint (watchpoint, etc)
5114 number BNUM. If BNUM is -1 print all user-settable breakpoints.
5115 If ALLFLAG is non-zero, include non-user-settable breakpoints. If
5116 FILTER is non-NULL, call it on each breakpoint and only include the
5117 ones for which it returns non-zero. Return the total number of
5118 breakpoints listed. */
5119
5120 static int
5121 breakpoint_1 (char *args, int allflag,
5122 int (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *))
5123 {
5124 struct breakpoint *b;
5125 struct bp_location *last_loc = NULL;
5126 int nr_printable_breakpoints;
5127 struct cleanup *bkpttbl_chain;
5128 struct value_print_options opts;
5129 int print_address_bits = 0;
5130 int print_type_col_width = 14;
5131
5132 get_user_print_options (&opts);
5133
5134 /* Compute the number of rows in the table, as well as the size
5135 required for address fields. */
5136 nr_printable_breakpoints = 0;
5137 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5138 {
5139 /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts. */
5140 if (filter && !filter (b))
5141 continue;
5142
5143 /* If we have an "args" string, it is a list of breakpoints to
5144 accept. Skip the others. */
5145 if (args != NULL && *args != '\0')
5146 {
5147 if (allflag && parse_and_eval_long (args) != b->number)
5148 continue;
5149 if (!allflag && !number_is_in_list (args, b->number))
5150 continue;
5151 }
5152
5153 if (allflag || user_breakpoint_p (b))
5154 {
5155 int addr_bit, type_len;
5156
5157 addr_bit = breakpoint_address_bits (b);
5158 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
5159 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
5160
5161 type_len = strlen (bptype_string (b->type));
5162 if (type_len > print_type_col_width)
5163 print_type_col_width = type_len;
5164
5165 nr_printable_breakpoints++;
5166 }
5167 }
5168
5169 if (opts.addressprint)
5170 bkpttbl_chain
5171 = make_cleanup_ui_out_table_begin_end (uiout, 6,
5172 nr_printable_breakpoints,
5173 "BreakpointTable");
5174 else
5175 bkpttbl_chain
5176 = make_cleanup_ui_out_table_begin_end (uiout, 5,
5177 nr_printable_breakpoints,
5178 "BreakpointTable");
5179
5180 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
5181 annotate_breakpoints_headers ();
5182 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
5183 annotate_field (0);
5184 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 7, ui_left, "number", "Num"); /* 1 */
5185 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
5186 annotate_field (1);
5187 ui_out_table_header (uiout, print_type_col_width, ui_left,
5188 "type", "Type"); /* 2 */
5189 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
5190 annotate_field (2);
5191 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 4, ui_left, "disp", "Disp"); /* 3 */
5192 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
5193 annotate_field (3);
5194 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 3, ui_left, "enabled", "Enb"); /* 4 */
5195 if (opts.addressprint)
5196 {
5197 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
5198 annotate_field (4);
5199 if (print_address_bits <= 32)
5200 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 10, ui_left,
5201 "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */
5202 else
5203 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 18, ui_left,
5204 "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */
5205 }
5206 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
5207 annotate_field (5);
5208 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 40, ui_noalign, "what", "What"); /* 6 */
5209 ui_out_table_body (uiout);
5210 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
5211 annotate_breakpoints_table ();
5212
5213 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5214 {
5215 QUIT;
5216 /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts. */
5217 if (filter && !filter (b))
5218 continue;
5219
5220 /* If we have an "args" string, it is a list of breakpoints to
5221 accept. Skip the others. */
5222
5223 if (args != NULL && *args != '\0')
5224 {
5225 if (allflag) /* maintenance info breakpoint */
5226 {
5227 if (parse_and_eval_long (args) != b->number)
5228 continue;
5229 }
5230 else /* all others */
5231 {
5232 if (!number_is_in_list (args, b->number))
5233 continue;
5234 }
5235 }
5236 /* We only print out user settable breakpoints unless the
5237 allflag is set. */
5238 if (allflag || user_breakpoint_p (b))
5239 print_one_breakpoint (b, &last_loc, allflag);
5240 }
5241
5242 do_cleanups (bkpttbl_chain);
5243
5244 if (nr_printable_breakpoints == 0)
5245 {
5246 /* If there's a filter, let the caller decide how to report
5247 empty list. */
5248 if (!filter)
5249 {
5250 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
5251 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No breakpoints or watchpoints.\n");
5252 else
5253 ui_out_message (uiout, 0,
5254 "No breakpoint or watchpoint matching '%s'.\n",
5255 args);
5256 }
5257 }
5258 else
5259 {
5260 if (last_loc && !server_command)
5261 set_next_address (last_loc->gdbarch, last_loc->address);
5262 }
5263
5264 /* FIXME? Should this be moved up so that it is only called when
5265 there have been breakpoints? */
5266 annotate_breakpoints_table_end ();
5267
5268 return nr_printable_breakpoints;
5269 }
5270
5271 /* Display the value of default-collect in a way that is generally
5272 compatible with the breakpoint list. */
5273
5274 static void
5275 default_collect_info (void)
5276 {
5277 /* If it has no value (which is frequently the case), say nothing; a
5278 message like "No default-collect." gets in user's face when it's
5279 not wanted. */
5280 if (!*default_collect)
5281 return;
5282
5283 /* The following phrase lines up nicely with per-tracepoint collect
5284 actions. */
5285 ui_out_text (uiout, "default collect ");
5286 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "default-collect", default_collect);
5287 ui_out_text (uiout, " \n");
5288 }
5289
5290 static void
5291 breakpoints_info (char *args, int from_tty)
5292 {
5293 breakpoint_1 (args, 0, NULL);
5294
5295 default_collect_info ();
5296 }
5297
5298 static void
5299 watchpoints_info (char *args, int from_tty)
5300 {
5301 int num_printed = breakpoint_1 (args, 0, is_watchpoint);
5302
5303 if (num_printed == 0)
5304 {
5305 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
5306 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No watchpoints.\n");
5307 else
5308 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No watchpoint matching '%s'.\n", args);
5309 }
5310 }
5311
5312 static void
5313 maintenance_info_breakpoints (char *args, int from_tty)
5314 {
5315 breakpoint_1 (args, 1, NULL);
5316
5317 default_collect_info ();
5318 }
5319
5320 static int
5321 breakpoint_has_pc (struct breakpoint *b,
5322 struct program_space *pspace,
5323 CORE_ADDR pc, struct obj_section *section)
5324 {
5325 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
5326
5327 for (; bl; bl = bl->next)
5328 {
5329 if (bl->pspace == pspace
5330 && bl->address == pc
5331 && (!overlay_debugging || bl->section == section))
5332 return 1;
5333 }
5334 return 0;
5335 }
5336
5337 /* Print a message describing any breakpoints set at PC. This
5338 concerns with logical breakpoints, so we match program spaces, not
5339 address spaces. */
5340
5341 static void
5342 describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
5343 struct program_space *pspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
5344 struct obj_section *section, int thread)
5345 {
5346 int others = 0;
5347 struct breakpoint *b;
5348
5349 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5350 others += breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section);
5351 if (others > 0)
5352 {
5353 if (others == 1)
5354 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoint "));
5355 else /* if (others == ???) */
5356 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoints "));
5357 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5358 if (breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section))
5359 {
5360 others--;
5361 printf_filtered ("%d", b->number);
5362 if (b->thread == -1 && thread != -1)
5363 printf_filtered (" (all threads)");
5364 else if (b->thread != -1)
5365 printf_filtered (" (thread %d)", b->thread);
5366 printf_filtered ("%s%s ",
5367 ((b->enable_state == bp_disabled
5368 || b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled
5369 || b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled)
5370 ? " (disabled)"
5371 : b->enable_state == bp_permanent
5372 ? " (permanent)"
5373 : ""),
5374 (others > 1) ? ","
5375 : ((others == 1) ? " and" : ""));
5376 }
5377 printf_filtered (_("also set at pc "));
5378 fputs_filtered (paddress (gdbarch, pc), gdb_stdout);
5379 printf_filtered (".\n");
5380 }
5381 }
5382 \f
5383 /* Set the default place to put a breakpoint
5384 for the `break' command with no arguments. */
5385
5386 void
5387 set_default_breakpoint (int valid, struct program_space *pspace,
5388 CORE_ADDR addr, struct symtab *symtab,
5389 int line)
5390 {
5391 default_breakpoint_valid = valid;
5392 default_breakpoint_pspace = pspace;
5393 default_breakpoint_address = addr;
5394 default_breakpoint_symtab = symtab;
5395 default_breakpoint_line = line;
5396 }
5397
5398 /* Return true iff it is meaningful to use the address member of
5399 BPT. For some breakpoint types, the address member is irrelevant
5400 and it makes no sense to attempt to compare it to other addresses
5401 (or use it for any other purpose either).
5402
5403 More specifically, each of the following breakpoint types will
5404 always have a zero valued address and we don't want to mark
5405 breakpoints of any of these types to be a duplicate of an actual
5406 breakpoint at address zero:
5407
5408 bp_watchpoint
5409 bp_catchpoint
5410
5411 */
5412
5413 static int
5414 breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (struct breakpoint *bpt)
5415 {
5416 enum bptype type = bpt->type;
5417
5418 return (type != bp_watchpoint && type != bp_catchpoint);
5419 }
5420
5421 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's owners are hardware watchpoints, returns
5422 true if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same watchpoint location. */
5423
5424 static int
5425 watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
5426 struct bp_location *loc2)
5427 {
5428 /* Both of them must not be in moribund_locations. */
5429 gdb_assert (loc1->owner != NULL);
5430 gdb_assert (loc2->owner != NULL);
5431
5432 /* If the target can evaluate the condition expression in hardware,
5433 then we we need to insert both watchpoints even if they are at
5434 the same place. Otherwise the watchpoint will only trigger when
5435 the condition of whichever watchpoint was inserted evaluates to
5436 true, not giving a chance for GDB to check the condition of the
5437 other watchpoint. */
5438 if ((loc1->owner->cond_exp
5439 && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc1->address,
5440 loc1->length,
5441 loc1->watchpoint_type,
5442 loc1->owner->cond_exp))
5443 || (loc2->owner->cond_exp
5444 && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc2->address,
5445 loc2->length,
5446 loc2->watchpoint_type,
5447 loc2->owner->cond_exp)))
5448 return 0;
5449
5450 /* Note that this checks the owner's type, not the location's. In
5451 case the target does not support read watchpoints, but does
5452 support access watchpoints, we'll have bp_read_watchpoint
5453 watchpoints with hw_access locations. Those should be considered
5454 duplicates of hw_read locations. The hw_read locations will
5455 become hw_access locations later. */
5456 return (loc1->owner->type == loc2->owner->type
5457 && loc1->pspace->aspace == loc2->pspace->aspace
5458 && loc1->address == loc2->address
5459 && loc1->length == loc2->length);
5460 }
5461
5462 /* Returns true if {ASPACE1,ADDR1} and {ASPACE2,ADDR2} represent the
5463 same breakpoint location. In most targets, this can only be true
5464 if ASPACE1 matches ASPACE2. On targets that have global
5465 breakpoints, the address space doesn't really matter. */
5466
5467 static int
5468 breakpoint_address_match (struct address_space *aspace1, CORE_ADDR addr1,
5469 struct address_space *aspace2, CORE_ADDR addr2)
5470 {
5471 return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch)
5472 || aspace1 == aspace2)
5473 && addr1 == addr2);
5474 }
5475
5476 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's types' have meaningful target addresses
5477 (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful), returns true if LOC1 and LOC2
5478 represent the same location. */
5479
5480 static int
5481 breakpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
5482 struct bp_location *loc2)
5483 {
5484 int hw_point1, hw_point2;
5485
5486 /* Both of them must not be in moribund_locations. */
5487 gdb_assert (loc1->owner != NULL);
5488 gdb_assert (loc2->owner != NULL);
5489
5490 hw_point1 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc1->owner);
5491 hw_point2 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner);
5492
5493 if (hw_point1 != hw_point2)
5494 return 0;
5495 else if (hw_point1)
5496 return watchpoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
5497 else
5498 return breakpoint_address_match (loc1->pspace->aspace, loc1->address,
5499 loc2->pspace->aspace, loc2->address);
5500 }
5501
5502 static void
5503 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR from_addr, CORE_ADDR to_addr,
5504 int bnum, int have_bnum)
5505 {
5506 /* The longest string possibly returned by hex_string_custom
5507 is 50 chars. These must be at least that big for safety. */
5508 char astr1[64];
5509 char astr2[64];
5510
5511 strcpy (astr1, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) from_addr, 8));
5512 strcpy (astr2, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) to_addr, 8));
5513 if (have_bnum)
5514 warning (_("Breakpoint %d address previously adjusted from %s to %s."),
5515 bnum, astr1, astr2);
5516 else
5517 warning (_("Breakpoint address adjusted from %s to %s."), astr1, astr2);
5518 }
5519
5520 /* Adjust a breakpoint's address to account for architectural
5521 constraints on breakpoint placement. Return the adjusted address.
5522 Note: Very few targets require this kind of adjustment. For most
5523 targets, this function is simply the identity function. */
5524
5525 static CORE_ADDR
5526 adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
5527 CORE_ADDR bpaddr, enum bptype bptype)
5528 {
5529 if (!gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address_p (gdbarch))
5530 {
5531 /* Very few targets need any kind of breakpoint adjustment. */
5532 return bpaddr;
5533 }
5534 else if (bptype == bp_watchpoint
5535 || bptype == bp_hardware_watchpoint
5536 || bptype == bp_read_watchpoint
5537 || bptype == bp_access_watchpoint
5538 || bptype == bp_catchpoint)
5539 {
5540 /* Watchpoints and the various bp_catch_* eventpoints should not
5541 have their addresses modified. */
5542 return bpaddr;
5543 }
5544 else
5545 {
5546 CORE_ADDR adjusted_bpaddr;
5547
5548 /* Some targets have architectural constraints on the placement
5549 of breakpoint instructions. Obtain the adjusted address. */
5550 adjusted_bpaddr = gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address (gdbarch, bpaddr);
5551
5552 /* An adjusted breakpoint address can significantly alter
5553 a user's expectations. Print a warning if an adjustment
5554 is required. */
5555 if (adjusted_bpaddr != bpaddr)
5556 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bpaddr, adjusted_bpaddr, 0, 0);
5557
5558 return adjusted_bpaddr;
5559 }
5560 }
5561
5562 /* Allocate a struct bp_location. */
5563
5564 static struct bp_location *
5565 allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt)
5566 {
5567 struct bp_location *loc;
5568
5569 loc = xmalloc (sizeof (struct bp_location));
5570 memset (loc, 0, sizeof (*loc));
5571
5572 loc->owner = bpt;
5573 loc->cond = NULL;
5574 loc->shlib_disabled = 0;
5575 loc->enabled = 1;
5576
5577 switch (bpt->type)
5578 {
5579 case bp_breakpoint:
5580 case bp_until:
5581 case bp_finish:
5582 case bp_longjmp:
5583 case bp_longjmp_resume:
5584 case bp_exception:
5585 case bp_exception_resume:
5586 case bp_step_resume:
5587 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
5588 case bp_call_dummy:
5589 case bp_std_terminate:
5590 case bp_shlib_event:
5591 case bp_thread_event:
5592 case bp_overlay_event:
5593 case bp_jit_event:
5594 case bp_longjmp_master:
5595 case bp_std_terminate_master:
5596 case bp_exception_master:
5597 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
5598 break;
5599 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
5600 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
5601 break;
5602 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
5603 case bp_read_watchpoint:
5604 case bp_access_watchpoint:
5605 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint;
5606 break;
5607 case bp_watchpoint:
5608 case bp_catchpoint:
5609 case bp_tracepoint:
5610 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
5611 case bp_static_tracepoint:
5612 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_other;
5613 break;
5614 default:
5615 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unknown breakpoint type"));
5616 }
5617
5618 loc->refc = 1;
5619 return loc;
5620 }
5621
5622 static void
5623 free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc)
5624 {
5625 if (loc->cond)
5626 xfree (loc->cond);
5627
5628 if (loc->function_name)
5629 xfree (loc->function_name);
5630
5631 xfree (loc);
5632 }
5633
5634 /* Increment reference count. */
5635
5636 static void
5637 incref_bp_location (struct bp_location *bl)
5638 {
5639 ++bl->refc;
5640 }
5641
5642 /* Decrement reference count. If the reference count reaches 0,
5643 destroy the bp_location. Sets *BLP to NULL. */
5644
5645 static void
5646 decref_bp_location (struct bp_location **blp)
5647 {
5648 gdb_assert ((*blp)->refc > 0);
5649
5650 if (--(*blp)->refc == 0)
5651 free_bp_location (*blp);
5652 *blp = NULL;
5653 }
5654
5655 /* Helper to set_raw_breakpoint below. Creates a breakpoint that has
5656 type BPTYPE and has no locations as yet. */
5657 /* This function is used in gdbtk sources and thus can not be made
5658 static. */
5659
5660 static struct breakpoint *
5661 set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
5662 enum bptype bptype)
5663 {
5664 struct breakpoint *b, *b1;
5665
5666 b = (struct breakpoint *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct breakpoint));
5667 memset (b, 0, sizeof (*b));
5668
5669 b->type = bptype;
5670 b->gdbarch = gdbarch;
5671 b->language = current_language->la_language;
5672 b->input_radix = input_radix;
5673 b->thread = -1;
5674 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5675 b->next = 0;
5676 b->silent = 0;
5677 b->ignore_count = 0;
5678 b->commands = NULL;
5679 b->frame_id = null_frame_id;
5680 b->forked_inferior_pid = null_ptid;
5681 b->exec_pathname = NULL;
5682 b->syscalls_to_be_caught = NULL;
5683 b->ops = NULL;
5684 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
5685 b->py_bp_object = NULL;
5686
5687 /* Add this breakpoint to the end of the chain so that a list of
5688 breakpoints will come out in order of increasing numbers. */
5689
5690 b1 = breakpoint_chain;
5691 if (b1 == 0)
5692 breakpoint_chain = b;
5693 else
5694 {
5695 while (b1->next)
5696 b1 = b1->next;
5697 b1->next = b;
5698 }
5699 return b;
5700 }
5701
5702 /* Initialize loc->function_name. */
5703 static void
5704 set_breakpoint_location_function (struct bp_location *loc)
5705 {
5706 gdb_assert (loc->owner != NULL);
5707
5708 if (loc->owner->type == bp_breakpoint
5709 || loc->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
5710 || is_tracepoint (loc->owner))
5711 {
5712 find_pc_partial_function (loc->address, &(loc->function_name),
5713 NULL, NULL);
5714 if (loc->function_name)
5715 loc->function_name = xstrdup (loc->function_name);
5716 }
5717 }
5718
5719 /* Attempt to determine architecture of location identified by SAL. */
5720 static struct gdbarch *
5721 get_sal_arch (struct symtab_and_line sal)
5722 {
5723 if (sal.section)
5724 return get_objfile_arch (sal.section->objfile);
5725 if (sal.symtab)
5726 return get_objfile_arch (sal.symtab->objfile);
5727
5728 return NULL;
5729 }
5730
5731 /* set_raw_breakpoint is a low level routine for allocating and
5732 partially initializing a breakpoint of type BPTYPE. The newly
5733 created breakpoint's address, section, source file name, and line
5734 number are provided by SAL. The newly created and partially
5735 initialized breakpoint is added to the breakpoint chain and
5736 is also returned as the value of this function.
5737
5738 It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
5739 the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
5740 information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. In
5741 particular, set_raw_breakpoint does NOT set the breakpoint
5742 number! Care should be taken to not allow an error to occur
5743 prior to completing the initialization of the breakpoint. If this
5744 should happen, a bogus breakpoint will be left on the chain. */
5745
5746 struct breakpoint *
5747 set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
5748 struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype)
5749 {
5750 struct breakpoint *b = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (gdbarch,
5751 bptype);
5752 CORE_ADDR adjusted_address;
5753 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch;
5754
5755 loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
5756 if (!loc_gdbarch)
5757 loc_gdbarch = b->gdbarch;
5758
5759 if (bptype != bp_catchpoint)
5760 gdb_assert (sal.pspace != NULL);
5761
5762 /* Adjust the breakpoint's address prior to allocating a location.
5763 Once we call allocate_bp_location(), that mostly uninitialized
5764 location will be placed on the location chain. Adjustment of the
5765 breakpoint may cause target_read_memory() to be called and we do
5766 not want its scan of the location chain to find a breakpoint and
5767 location that's only been partially initialized. */
5768 adjusted_address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc_gdbarch,
5769 sal.pc, b->type);
5770
5771 b->loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
5772 b->loc->gdbarch = loc_gdbarch;
5773 b->loc->requested_address = sal.pc;
5774 b->loc->address = adjusted_address;
5775 b->loc->pspace = sal.pspace;
5776
5777 /* Store the program space that was used to set the breakpoint, for
5778 breakpoint resetting. */
5779 b->pspace = sal.pspace;
5780
5781 if (sal.symtab == NULL)
5782 b->source_file = NULL;
5783 else
5784 b->source_file = xstrdup (sal.symtab->filename);
5785 b->loc->section = sal.section;
5786 b->line_number = sal.line;
5787
5788 set_breakpoint_location_function (b->loc);
5789
5790 breakpoints_changed ();
5791
5792 return b;
5793 }
5794
5795
5796 /* Note that the breakpoint object B describes a permanent breakpoint
5797 instruction, hard-wired into the inferior's code. */
5798 void
5799 make_breakpoint_permanent (struct breakpoint *b)
5800 {
5801 struct bp_location *bl;
5802
5803 b->enable_state = bp_permanent;
5804
5805 /* By definition, permanent breakpoints are already present in the
5806 code. Mark all locations as inserted. For now,
5807 make_breakpoint_permanent is called in just one place, so it's
5808 hard to say if it's reasonable to have permanent breakpoint with
5809 multiple locations or not, but it's easy to implmement. */
5810 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
5811 bl->inserted = 1;
5812 }
5813
5814 /* Call this routine when stepping and nexting to enable a breakpoint
5815 if we do a longjmp() or 'throw' in TP. FRAME is the frame which
5816 initiated the operation. */
5817
5818 void
5819 set_longjmp_breakpoint (struct thread_info *tp, struct frame_id frame)
5820 {
5821 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
5822 int thread = tp->num;
5823
5824 /* To avoid having to rescan all objfile symbols at every step,
5825 we maintain a list of continually-inserted but always disabled
5826 longjmp "master" breakpoints. Here, we simply create momentary
5827 clones of those and enable them for the requested thread. */
5828 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
5829 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
5830 && (b->type == bp_longjmp_master
5831 || b->type == bp_exception_master))
5832 {
5833 struct breakpoint *clone = clone_momentary_breakpoint (b);
5834
5835 clone->type = b->type == bp_longjmp_master ? bp_longjmp : bp_exception;
5836 clone->thread = thread;
5837 }
5838
5839 tp->initiating_frame = frame;
5840 }
5841
5842 /* Delete all longjmp breakpoints from THREAD. */
5843 void
5844 delete_longjmp_breakpoint (int thread)
5845 {
5846 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
5847
5848 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
5849 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_exception)
5850 {
5851 if (b->thread == thread)
5852 delete_breakpoint (b);
5853 }
5854 }
5855
5856 void
5857 enable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
5858 {
5859 struct breakpoint *b;
5860
5861 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5862 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
5863 {
5864 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5865 update_global_location_list (1);
5866 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
5867 }
5868 }
5869
5870 void
5871 disable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
5872 {
5873 struct breakpoint *b;
5874
5875 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5876 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
5877 {
5878 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
5879 update_global_location_list (0);
5880 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
5881 }
5882 }
5883
5884 /* Set an active std::terminate breakpoint for each std::terminate
5885 master breakpoint. */
5886 void
5887 set_std_terminate_breakpoint (void)
5888 {
5889 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
5890
5891 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
5892 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
5893 && b->type == bp_std_terminate_master)
5894 {
5895 struct breakpoint *clone = clone_momentary_breakpoint (b);
5896 clone->type = bp_std_terminate;
5897 }
5898 }
5899
5900 /* Delete all the std::terminate breakpoints. */
5901 void
5902 delete_std_terminate_breakpoint (void)
5903 {
5904 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
5905
5906 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
5907 if (b->type == bp_std_terminate)
5908 delete_breakpoint (b);
5909 }
5910
5911 struct breakpoint *
5912 create_thread_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
5913 {
5914 struct breakpoint *b;
5915
5916 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_thread_event);
5917
5918 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5919 /* addr_string has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete me. */
5920 b->addr_string
5921 = xstrprintf ("*%s", paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address));
5922
5923 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
5924
5925 return b;
5926 }
5927
5928 void
5929 remove_thread_event_breakpoints (void)
5930 {
5931 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
5932
5933 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
5934 if (b->type == bp_thread_event
5935 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
5936 delete_breakpoint (b);
5937 }
5938
5939 struct captured_parse_breakpoint_args
5940 {
5941 char **arg_p;
5942 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals_p;
5943 char ***addr_string_p;
5944 int *not_found_ptr;
5945 };
5946
5947 struct lang_and_radix
5948 {
5949 enum language lang;
5950 int radix;
5951 };
5952
5953 /* Create a breakpoint for JIT code registration and unregistration. */
5954
5955 struct breakpoint *
5956 create_jit_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
5957 {
5958 struct breakpoint *b;
5959
5960 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_jit_event);
5961 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
5962 return b;
5963 }
5964
5965 /* Remove JIT code registration and unregistration breakpoint(s). */
5966
5967 void
5968 remove_jit_event_breakpoints (void)
5969 {
5970 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
5971
5972 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
5973 if (b->type == bp_jit_event
5974 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
5975 delete_breakpoint (b);
5976 }
5977
5978 void
5979 remove_solib_event_breakpoints (void)
5980 {
5981 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
5982
5983 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
5984 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event
5985 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
5986 delete_breakpoint (b);
5987 }
5988
5989 struct breakpoint *
5990 create_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
5991 {
5992 struct breakpoint *b;
5993
5994 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_shlib_event);
5995 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
5996 return b;
5997 }
5998
5999 /* Disable any breakpoints that are on code in shared libraries. Only
6000 apply to enabled breakpoints, disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
6001
6002 void
6003 disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs (void)
6004 {
6005 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
6006
6007 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
6008 {
6009 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
6010 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
6011
6012 /* We apply the check to all breakpoints, including disabled for
6013 those with loc->duplicate set. This is so that when breakpoint
6014 becomes enabled, or the duplicate is removed, gdb will try to
6015 insert all breakpoints. If we don't set shlib_disabled here,
6016 we'll try to insert those breakpoints and fail. */
6017 if (((b->type == bp_breakpoint)
6018 || (b->type == bp_jit_event)
6019 || (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
6020 || (is_tracepoint (b)))
6021 && loc->pspace == current_program_space
6022 && !loc->shlib_disabled
6023 #ifdef PC_SOLIB
6024 && PC_SOLIB (loc->address)
6025 #else
6026 && solib_name_from_address (loc->pspace, loc->address)
6027 #endif
6028 )
6029 {
6030 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
6031 }
6032 }
6033 }
6034
6035 /* Disable any breakpoints that are in in an unloaded shared library.
6036 Only apply to enabled breakpoints, disabled ones can just stay
6037 disabled. */
6038
6039 static void
6040 disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib (struct so_list *solib)
6041 {
6042 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
6043 int disabled_shlib_breaks = 0;
6044
6045 /* SunOS a.out shared libraries are always mapped, so do not
6046 disable breakpoints; they will only be reported as unloaded
6047 through clear_solib when GDB discards its shared library
6048 list. See clear_solib for more information. */
6049 if (exec_bfd != NULL
6050 && bfd_get_flavour (exec_bfd) == bfd_target_aout_flavour)
6051 return;
6052
6053 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
6054 {
6055 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
6056 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
6057
6058 if ((loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
6059 || loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
6060 && solib->pspace == loc->pspace
6061 && !loc->shlib_disabled
6062 && (b->type == bp_breakpoint
6063 || b->type == bp_jit_event
6064 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
6065 && solib_contains_address_p (solib, loc->address))
6066 {
6067 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
6068 /* At this point, we cannot rely on remove_breakpoint
6069 succeeding so we must mark the breakpoint as not inserted
6070 to prevent future errors occurring in remove_breakpoints. */
6071 loc->inserted = 0;
6072 if (!disabled_shlib_breaks)
6073 {
6074 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
6075 warning (_("Temporarily disabling breakpoints "
6076 "for unloaded shared library \"%s\""),
6077 solib->so_name);
6078 }
6079 disabled_shlib_breaks = 1;
6080 }
6081 }
6082 }
6083
6084 /* FORK & VFORK catchpoints. */
6085
6086 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for fork
6087 catchpoints. */
6088
6089 static int
6090 insert_catch_fork (struct bp_location *bl)
6091 {
6092 return target_insert_fork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
6093 }
6094
6095 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for fork
6096 catchpoints. */
6097
6098 static int
6099 remove_catch_fork (struct bp_location *bl)
6100 {
6101 return target_remove_fork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
6102 }
6103
6104 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for fork
6105 catchpoints. */
6106
6107 static int
6108 breakpoint_hit_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
6109 {
6110 return inferior_has_forked (inferior_ptid, &b->forked_inferior_pid);
6111 }
6112
6113 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for fork
6114 catchpoints. */
6115
6116 static enum print_stop_action
6117 print_it_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
6118 {
6119 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
6120 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (forked process %d), "),
6121 b->number, ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
6122 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
6123 }
6124
6125 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for fork
6126 catchpoints. */
6127
6128 static void
6129 print_one_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
6130 {
6131 struct value_print_options opts;
6132
6133 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6134
6135 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
6136 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
6137 readable). */
6138 if (opts.addressprint)
6139 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
6140 annotate_field (5);
6141 ui_out_text (uiout, "fork");
6142 if (!ptid_equal (b->forked_inferior_pid, null_ptid))
6143 {
6144 ui_out_text (uiout, ", process ");
6145 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "what",
6146 ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
6147 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 1);
6148 }
6149 }
6150
6151 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for fork
6152 catchpoints. */
6153
6154 static void
6155 print_mention_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
6156 {
6157 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (fork)"), b->number);
6158 }
6159
6160 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for fork
6161 catchpoints. */
6162
6163 static void
6164 print_recreate_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
6165 {
6166 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch fork");
6167 }
6168
6169 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in fork catchpoints. */
6170
6171 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_fork_breakpoint_ops =
6172 {
6173 insert_catch_fork,
6174 remove_catch_fork,
6175 breakpoint_hit_catch_fork,
6176 NULL, /* resources_needed */
6177 print_it_catch_fork,
6178 print_one_catch_fork,
6179 print_mention_catch_fork,
6180 print_recreate_catch_fork
6181 };
6182
6183 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
6184 catchpoints. */
6185
6186 static int
6187 insert_catch_vfork (struct bp_location *bl)
6188 {
6189 return target_insert_vfork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
6190 }
6191
6192 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
6193 catchpoints. */
6194
6195 static int
6196 remove_catch_vfork (struct bp_location *bl)
6197 {
6198 return target_remove_vfork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
6199 }
6200
6201 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
6202 catchpoints. */
6203
6204 static int
6205 breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
6206 {
6207 return inferior_has_vforked (inferior_ptid, &b->forked_inferior_pid);
6208 }
6209
6210 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
6211 catchpoints. */
6212
6213 static enum print_stop_action
6214 print_it_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
6215 {
6216 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
6217 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (vforked process %d), "),
6218 b->number, ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
6219 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
6220 }
6221
6222 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
6223 catchpoints. */
6224
6225 static void
6226 print_one_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
6227 {
6228 struct value_print_options opts;
6229
6230 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6231 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
6232 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
6233 readable). */
6234 if (opts.addressprint)
6235 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
6236 annotate_field (5);
6237 ui_out_text (uiout, "vfork");
6238 if (!ptid_equal (b->forked_inferior_pid, null_ptid))
6239 {
6240 ui_out_text (uiout, ", process ");
6241 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "what",
6242 ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
6243 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 1);
6244 }
6245 }
6246
6247 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
6248 catchpoints. */
6249
6250 static void
6251 print_mention_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
6252 {
6253 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (vfork)"), b->number);
6254 }
6255
6256 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
6257 catchpoints. */
6258
6259 static void
6260 print_recreate_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
6261 {
6262 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch vfork");
6263 }
6264
6265 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in vfork catchpoints. */
6266
6267 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops =
6268 {
6269 insert_catch_vfork,
6270 remove_catch_vfork,
6271 breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork,
6272 NULL, /* resources_needed */
6273 print_it_catch_vfork,
6274 print_one_catch_vfork,
6275 print_mention_catch_vfork,
6276 print_recreate_catch_vfork
6277 };
6278
6279 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
6280 catchpoints. */
6281
6282 static int
6283 insert_catch_syscall (struct bp_location *bl)
6284 {
6285 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
6286
6287 ++inf->total_syscalls_count;
6288 if (!bl->owner->syscalls_to_be_caught)
6289 ++inf->any_syscall_count;
6290 else
6291 {
6292 int i, iter;
6293
6294 for (i = 0;
6295 VEC_iterate (int, bl->owner->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
6296 i++)
6297 {
6298 int elem;
6299
6300 if (iter >= VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts))
6301 {
6302 int old_size = VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts);
6303 uintptr_t vec_addr_offset
6304 = old_size * ((uintptr_t) sizeof (int));
6305 uintptr_t vec_addr;
6306 VEC_safe_grow (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter + 1);
6307 vec_addr = (uintptr_t) VEC_address (int, inf->syscalls_counts) +
6308 vec_addr_offset;
6309 memset ((void *) vec_addr, 0,
6310 (iter + 1 - old_size) * sizeof (int));
6311 }
6312 elem = VEC_index (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter);
6313 VEC_replace (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter, ++elem);
6314 }
6315 }
6316
6317 return target_set_syscall_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid),
6318 inf->total_syscalls_count != 0,
6319 inf->any_syscall_count,
6320 VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts),
6321 VEC_address (int, inf->syscalls_counts));
6322 }
6323
6324 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
6325 catchpoints. */
6326
6327 static int
6328 remove_catch_syscall (struct bp_location *bl)
6329 {
6330 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
6331
6332 --inf->total_syscalls_count;
6333 if (!bl->owner->syscalls_to_be_caught)
6334 --inf->any_syscall_count;
6335 else
6336 {
6337 int i, iter;
6338
6339 for (i = 0;
6340 VEC_iterate (int, bl->owner->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
6341 i++)
6342 {
6343 int elem;
6344 if (iter >= VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts))
6345 /* Shouldn't happen. */
6346 continue;
6347 elem = VEC_index (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter);
6348 VEC_replace (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter, --elem);
6349 }
6350 }
6351
6352 return target_set_syscall_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid),
6353 inf->total_syscalls_count != 0,
6354 inf->any_syscall_count,
6355 VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts),
6356 VEC_address (int,
6357 inf->syscalls_counts));
6358 }
6359
6360 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
6361 catchpoints. */
6362
6363 static int
6364 breakpoint_hit_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
6365 {
6366 /* We must check if we are catching specific syscalls in this
6367 breakpoint. If we are, then we must guarantee that the called
6368 syscall is the same syscall we are catching. */
6369 int syscall_number = 0;
6370
6371 if (!inferior_has_called_syscall (inferior_ptid, &syscall_number))
6372 return 0;
6373
6374 /* Now, checking if the syscall is the same. */
6375 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
6376 {
6377 int i, iter;
6378
6379 for (i = 0;
6380 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
6381 i++)
6382 if (syscall_number == iter)
6383 break;
6384 /* Not the same. */
6385 if (!iter)
6386 return 0;
6387 }
6388
6389 return 1;
6390 }
6391
6392 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
6393 catchpoints. */
6394
6395 static enum print_stop_action
6396 print_it_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
6397 {
6398 /* These are needed because we want to know in which state a
6399 syscall is. It can be in the TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_ENTRY
6400 or TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_RETURN, and depending on it we
6401 must print "called syscall" or "returned from syscall". */
6402 ptid_t ptid;
6403 struct target_waitstatus last;
6404 struct syscall s;
6405 struct cleanup *old_chain;
6406 char *syscall_id;
6407
6408 get_last_target_status (&ptid, &last);
6409
6410 get_syscall_by_number (last.value.syscall_number, &s);
6411
6412 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
6413
6414 if (s.name == NULL)
6415 syscall_id = xstrprintf ("%d", last.value.syscall_number);
6416 else
6417 syscall_id = xstrprintf ("'%s'", s.name);
6418
6419 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, syscall_id);
6420
6421 if (last.kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_ENTRY)
6422 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (call to syscall %s), "),
6423 b->number, syscall_id);
6424 else if (last.kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_RETURN)
6425 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (returned from syscall %s), "),
6426 b->number, syscall_id);
6427
6428 do_cleanups (old_chain);
6429
6430 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
6431 }
6432
6433 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
6434 catchpoints. */
6435
6436 static void
6437 print_one_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b,
6438 struct bp_location **last_loc)
6439 {
6440 struct value_print_options opts;
6441
6442 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6443 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
6444 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
6445 readable). */
6446 if (opts.addressprint)
6447 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
6448 annotate_field (5);
6449
6450 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught
6451 && VEC_length (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught) > 1)
6452 ui_out_text (uiout, "syscalls \"");
6453 else
6454 ui_out_text (uiout, "syscall \"");
6455
6456 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
6457 {
6458 int i, iter;
6459 char *text = xstrprintf ("%s", "");
6460
6461 for (i = 0;
6462 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
6463 i++)
6464 {
6465 char *x = text;
6466 struct syscall s;
6467 get_syscall_by_number (iter, &s);
6468
6469 if (s.name != NULL)
6470 text = xstrprintf ("%s%s, ", text, s.name);
6471 else
6472 text = xstrprintf ("%s%d, ", text, iter);
6473
6474 /* We have to xfree the last 'text' (now stored at 'x')
6475 because xstrprintf dinamically allocates new space for it
6476 on every call. */
6477 xfree (x);
6478 }
6479 /* Remove the last comma. */
6480 text[strlen (text) - 2] = '\0';
6481 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", text);
6482 }
6483 else
6484 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "<any syscall>");
6485 ui_out_text (uiout, "\" ");
6486 }
6487
6488 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
6489 catchpoints. */
6490
6491 static void
6492 print_mention_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
6493 {
6494 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
6495 {
6496 int i, iter;
6497
6498 if (VEC_length (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught) > 1)
6499 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (syscalls"), b->number);
6500 else
6501 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (syscall"), b->number);
6502
6503 for (i = 0;
6504 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
6505 i++)
6506 {
6507 struct syscall s;
6508 get_syscall_by_number (iter, &s);
6509
6510 if (s.name)
6511 printf_filtered (" '%s' [%d]", s.name, s.number);
6512 else
6513 printf_filtered (" %d", s.number);
6514 }
6515 printf_filtered (")");
6516 }
6517 else
6518 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (any syscall)"),
6519 b->number);
6520 }
6521
6522 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
6523 catchpoints. */
6524
6525 static void
6526 print_recreate_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
6527 {
6528 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch syscall");
6529
6530 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
6531 {
6532 int i, iter;
6533
6534 for (i = 0;
6535 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
6536 i++)
6537 {
6538 struct syscall s;
6539
6540 get_syscall_by_number (iter, &s);
6541 if (s.name)
6542 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", s.name);
6543 else
6544 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %d", s.number);
6545 }
6546 }
6547 }
6548
6549 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in syscall catchpoints. */
6550
6551 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops =
6552 {
6553 insert_catch_syscall,
6554 remove_catch_syscall,
6555 breakpoint_hit_catch_syscall,
6556 NULL, /* resources_needed */
6557 print_it_catch_syscall,
6558 print_one_catch_syscall,
6559 print_mention_catch_syscall,
6560 print_recreate_catch_syscall
6561 };
6562
6563 /* Returns non-zero if 'b' is a syscall catchpoint. */
6564
6565 static int
6566 syscall_catchpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
6567 {
6568 return (b->ops == &catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops);
6569 }
6570
6571 /* Create a new breakpoint of the bp_catchpoint kind and return it,
6572 but does NOT mention it nor update the global location list.
6573 This is useful if you need to fill more fields in the
6574 struct breakpoint before calling mention.
6575
6576 If TEMPFLAG is non-zero, then make the breakpoint temporary.
6577 If COND_STRING is not NULL, then store it in the breakpoint.
6578 OPS, if not NULL, is the breakpoint_ops structure associated
6579 to the catchpoint. */
6580
6581 static struct breakpoint *
6582 create_catchpoint_without_mention (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, int tempflag,
6583 char *cond_string,
6584 struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
6585 {
6586 struct symtab_and_line sal;
6587 struct breakpoint *b;
6588
6589 init_sal (&sal);
6590 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
6591
6592 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, bp_catchpoint);
6593 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
6594 b->number = breakpoint_count;
6595
6596 b->cond_string = (cond_string == NULL) ? NULL : xstrdup (cond_string);
6597 b->thread = -1;
6598 b->addr_string = NULL;
6599 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
6600 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
6601 b->ops = ops;
6602
6603 return b;
6604 }
6605
6606 /* Create a new breakpoint of the bp_catchpoint kind and return it.
6607
6608 If TEMPFLAG is non-zero, then make the breakpoint temporary.
6609 If COND_STRING is not NULL, then store it in the breakpoint.
6610 OPS, if not NULL, is the breakpoint_ops structure associated
6611 to the catchpoint. */
6612
6613 static struct breakpoint *
6614 create_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, int tempflag,
6615 char *cond_string, struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
6616 {
6617 struct breakpoint *b =
6618 create_catchpoint_without_mention (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string, ops);
6619
6620 mention (b);
6621 update_global_location_list (1);
6622
6623 return b;
6624 }
6625
6626 static void
6627 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6628 int tempflag, char *cond_string,
6629 struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
6630 {
6631 struct breakpoint *b
6632 = create_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string, ops);
6633
6634 /* FIXME: We should put this information in a breakpoint private data
6635 area. */
6636 b->forked_inferior_pid = null_ptid;
6637 }
6638
6639 /* Exec catchpoints. */
6640
6641 static int
6642 insert_catch_exec (struct bp_location *bl)
6643 {
6644 return target_insert_exec_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
6645 }
6646
6647 static int
6648 remove_catch_exec (struct bp_location *bl)
6649 {
6650 return target_remove_exec_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
6651 }
6652
6653 static int
6654 breakpoint_hit_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
6655 {
6656 return inferior_has_execd (inferior_ptid, &b->exec_pathname);
6657 }
6658
6659 static enum print_stop_action
6660 print_it_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
6661 {
6662 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
6663 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (exec'd %s), "), b->number,
6664 b->exec_pathname);
6665 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
6666 }
6667
6668 static void
6669 print_one_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
6670 {
6671 struct value_print_options opts;
6672
6673 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6674
6675 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
6676 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
6677 is relatively readable). */
6678 if (opts.addressprint)
6679 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
6680 annotate_field (5);
6681 ui_out_text (uiout, "exec");
6682 if (b->exec_pathname != NULL)
6683 {
6684 ui_out_text (uiout, ", program \"");
6685 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", b->exec_pathname);
6686 ui_out_text (uiout, "\" ");
6687 }
6688 }
6689
6690 static void
6691 print_mention_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
6692 {
6693 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (exec)"), b->number);
6694 }
6695
6696 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for exec
6697 catchpoints. */
6698
6699 static void
6700 print_recreate_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
6701 {
6702 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch exec");
6703 }
6704
6705 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exec_breakpoint_ops =
6706 {
6707 insert_catch_exec,
6708 remove_catch_exec,
6709 breakpoint_hit_catch_exec,
6710 NULL, /* resources_needed */
6711 print_it_catch_exec,
6712 print_one_catch_exec,
6713 print_mention_catch_exec,
6714 print_recreate_catch_exec
6715 };
6716
6717 static void
6718 create_syscall_event_catchpoint (int tempflag, VEC(int) *filter,
6719 struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
6720 {
6721 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
6722 struct breakpoint *b =
6723 create_catchpoint_without_mention (gdbarch, tempflag, NULL, ops);
6724
6725 b->syscalls_to_be_caught = filter;
6726
6727 /* Now, we have to mention the breakpoint and update the global
6728 location list. */
6729 mention (b);
6730 update_global_location_list (1);
6731 }
6732
6733 static int
6734 hw_breakpoint_used_count (void)
6735 {
6736 struct breakpoint *b;
6737 int i = 0;
6738
6739 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6740 {
6741 if (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint && breakpoint_enabled (b))
6742 i++;
6743 }
6744
6745 return i;
6746 }
6747
6748 static int
6749 hw_watchpoint_used_count (enum bptype type, int *other_type_used)
6750 {
6751 int i = 0;
6752 struct breakpoint *b;
6753 struct bp_location *bl;
6754
6755 *other_type_used = 0;
6756 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6757 {
6758 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
6759 continue;
6760
6761 if (b->type == type)
6762 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
6763 {
6764 /* Special types of hardware watchpoints may use more than
6765 one register. */
6766 if (b->ops && b->ops->resources_needed)
6767 i += b->ops->resources_needed (bl);
6768 else
6769 i++;
6770 }
6771 else if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
6772 *other_type_used = 1;
6773 }
6774
6775 return i;
6776 }
6777
6778 void
6779 disable_watchpoints_before_interactive_call_start (void)
6780 {
6781 struct breakpoint *b;
6782
6783 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6784 {
6785 if (is_watchpoint (b) && breakpoint_enabled (b))
6786 {
6787 b->enable_state = bp_call_disabled;
6788 update_global_location_list (0);
6789 }
6790 }
6791 }
6792
6793 void
6794 enable_watchpoints_after_interactive_call_stop (void)
6795 {
6796 struct breakpoint *b;
6797
6798 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6799 {
6800 if (is_watchpoint (b) && b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled)
6801 {
6802 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
6803 update_global_location_list (1);
6804 }
6805 }
6806 }
6807
6808 void
6809 disable_breakpoints_before_startup (void)
6810 {
6811 struct breakpoint *b;
6812 int found = 0;
6813
6814 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6815 {
6816 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
6817 continue;
6818
6819 if ((b->type == bp_breakpoint
6820 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
6821 && breakpoint_enabled (b))
6822 {
6823 b->enable_state = bp_startup_disabled;
6824 found = 1;
6825 }
6826 }
6827
6828 if (found)
6829 update_global_location_list (0);
6830
6831 current_program_space->executing_startup = 1;
6832 }
6833
6834 void
6835 enable_breakpoints_after_startup (void)
6836 {
6837 struct breakpoint *b;
6838 int found = 0;
6839
6840 current_program_space->executing_startup = 0;
6841
6842 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6843 {
6844 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
6845 continue;
6846
6847 if ((b->type == bp_breakpoint
6848 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
6849 && b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled)
6850 {
6851 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
6852 found = 1;
6853 }
6854 }
6855
6856 if (found)
6857 breakpoint_re_set ();
6858 }
6859
6860
6861 /* Set a breakpoint that will evaporate an end of command
6862 at address specified by SAL.
6863 Restrict it to frame FRAME if FRAME is nonzero. */
6864
6865 struct breakpoint *
6866 set_momentary_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, struct symtab_and_line sal,
6867 struct frame_id frame_id, enum bptype type)
6868 {
6869 struct breakpoint *b;
6870
6871 /* If FRAME_ID is valid, it should be a real frame, not an inlined
6872 one. */
6873 gdb_assert (!frame_id_inlined_p (frame_id));
6874
6875 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type);
6876 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
6877 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
6878 b->frame_id = frame_id;
6879
6880 /* If we're debugging a multi-threaded program, then we want
6881 momentary breakpoints to be active in only a single thread of
6882 control. */
6883 if (in_thread_list (inferior_ptid))
6884 b->thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
6885
6886 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
6887
6888 return b;
6889 }
6890
6891 /* Make a deep copy of momentary breakpoint ORIG. Returns NULL if
6892 ORIG is NULL. */
6893
6894 struct breakpoint *
6895 clone_momentary_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *orig)
6896 {
6897 struct breakpoint *copy;
6898
6899 /* If there's nothing to clone, then return nothing. */
6900 if (orig == NULL)
6901 return NULL;
6902
6903 copy = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (orig->gdbarch, orig->type);
6904 copy->loc = allocate_bp_location (copy);
6905 set_breakpoint_location_function (copy->loc);
6906
6907 copy->loc->gdbarch = orig->loc->gdbarch;
6908 copy->loc->requested_address = orig->loc->requested_address;
6909 copy->loc->address = orig->loc->address;
6910 copy->loc->section = orig->loc->section;
6911 copy->loc->pspace = orig->loc->pspace;
6912
6913 if (orig->source_file == NULL)
6914 copy->source_file = NULL;
6915 else
6916 copy->source_file = xstrdup (orig->source_file);
6917
6918 copy->line_number = orig->line_number;
6919 copy->frame_id = orig->frame_id;
6920 copy->thread = orig->thread;
6921 copy->pspace = orig->pspace;
6922
6923 copy->enable_state = bp_enabled;
6924 copy->disposition = disp_donttouch;
6925 copy->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
6926
6927 update_global_location_list_nothrow (0);
6928 return copy;
6929 }
6930
6931 struct breakpoint *
6932 set_momentary_breakpoint_at_pc (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR pc,
6933 enum bptype type)
6934 {
6935 struct symtab_and_line sal;
6936
6937 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
6938 sal.pc = pc;
6939 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc);
6940 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
6941
6942 return set_momentary_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, null_frame_id, type);
6943 }
6944 \f
6945
6946 /* Tell the user we have just set a breakpoint B. */
6947
6948 static void
6949 mention (struct breakpoint *b)
6950 {
6951 int say_where = 0;
6952 struct cleanup *ui_out_chain;
6953 struct value_print_options opts;
6954
6955 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6956
6957 /* FIXME: This is misplaced; mention() is called by things (like
6958 hitting a watchpoint) other than breakpoint creation. It should
6959 be possible to clean this up and at the same time replace the
6960 random calls to breakpoint_changed with this hook. */
6961 observer_notify_breakpoint_created (b->number);
6962
6963 if (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_mention != NULL)
6964 b->ops->print_mention (b);
6965 else
6966 switch (b->type)
6967 {
6968 case bp_none:
6969 printf_filtered (_("(apparently deleted?) Eventpoint %d: "),
6970 b->number);
6971 break;
6972 case bp_watchpoint:
6973 ui_out_text (uiout, "Watchpoint ");
6974 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "wpt");
6975 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6976 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6977 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6978 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6979 break;
6980 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
6981 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware watchpoint ");
6982 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "wpt");
6983 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6984 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6985 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6986 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6987 break;
6988 case bp_read_watchpoint:
6989 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware read watchpoint ");
6990 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-rwpt");
6991 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6992 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6993 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6994 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6995 break;
6996 case bp_access_watchpoint:
6997 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
6998 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-awpt");
6999 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
7000 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
7001 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
7002 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
7003 break;
7004 case bp_breakpoint:
7005 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
7006 {
7007 say_where = 0;
7008 break;
7009 }
7010 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
7011 printf_filtered (_("Temporary breakpoint"));
7012 else
7013 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint"));
7014 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
7015 say_where = 1;
7016 break;
7017 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
7018 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
7019 {
7020 say_where = 0;
7021 break;
7022 }
7023 printf_filtered (_("Hardware assisted breakpoint %d"), b->number);
7024 say_where = 1;
7025 break;
7026 case bp_tracepoint:
7027 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
7028 {
7029 say_where = 0;
7030 break;
7031 }
7032 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoint"));
7033 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
7034 say_where = 1;
7035 break;
7036 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
7037 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
7038 {
7039 say_where = 0;
7040 break;
7041 }
7042 printf_filtered (_("Fast tracepoint"));
7043 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
7044 say_where = 1;
7045 break;
7046 case bp_static_tracepoint:
7047 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
7048 {
7049 say_where = 0;
7050 break;
7051 }
7052 printf_filtered (_("Static tracepoint"));
7053 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
7054 say_where = 1;
7055 break;
7056
7057 case bp_until:
7058 case bp_finish:
7059 case bp_longjmp:
7060 case bp_longjmp_resume:
7061 case bp_exception:
7062 case bp_exception_resume:
7063 case bp_step_resume:
7064 case bp_call_dummy:
7065 case bp_std_terminate:
7066 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
7067 case bp_shlib_event:
7068 case bp_thread_event:
7069 case bp_overlay_event:
7070 case bp_jit_event:
7071 case bp_longjmp_master:
7072 case bp_std_terminate_master:
7073 case bp_exception_master:
7074 break;
7075 }
7076
7077 if (say_where)
7078 {
7079 /* i18n: cagney/2005-02-11: Below needs to be merged into a
7080 single string. */
7081 if (b->loc == NULL)
7082 {
7083 printf_filtered (_(" (%s) pending."), b->addr_string);
7084 }
7085 else
7086 {
7087 if (opts.addressprint || b->source_file == NULL)
7088 {
7089 printf_filtered (" at ");
7090 fputs_filtered (paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address),
7091 gdb_stdout);
7092 }
7093 if (b->source_file)
7094 printf_filtered (": file %s, line %d.",
7095 b->source_file, b->line_number);
7096
7097 if (b->loc->next)
7098 {
7099 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
7100 int n = 0;
7101 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
7102 ++n;
7103 printf_filtered (" (%d locations)", n);
7104 }
7105
7106 }
7107 }
7108 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
7109 return;
7110 printf_filtered ("\n");
7111 }
7112 \f
7113
7114 static struct bp_location *
7115 add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
7116 const struct symtab_and_line *sal)
7117 {
7118 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
7119
7120 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
7121 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL; tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
7122 ;
7123 *tmp = loc;
7124 loc->gdbarch = get_sal_arch (*sal);
7125 if (!loc->gdbarch)
7126 loc->gdbarch = b->gdbarch;
7127 loc->requested_address = sal->pc;
7128 loc->address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc->gdbarch,
7129 loc->requested_address, b->type);
7130 loc->pspace = sal->pspace;
7131 gdb_assert (loc->pspace != NULL);
7132 loc->section = sal->section;
7133
7134 set_breakpoint_location_function (loc);
7135 return loc;
7136 }
7137 \f
7138
7139 /* Return 1 if LOC is pointing to a permanent breakpoint,
7140 return 0 otherwise. */
7141
7142 static int
7143 bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc)
7144 {
7145 int len;
7146 CORE_ADDR addr;
7147 const gdb_byte *brk;
7148 gdb_byte *target_mem;
7149 struct cleanup *cleanup;
7150 int retval = 0;
7151
7152 gdb_assert (loc != NULL);
7153
7154 addr = loc->address;
7155 brk = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (loc->gdbarch, &addr, &len);
7156
7157 /* Software breakpoints unsupported? */
7158 if (brk == NULL)
7159 return 0;
7160
7161 target_mem = alloca (len);
7162
7163 /* Enable the automatic memory restoration from breakpoints while
7164 we read the memory. Otherwise we could say about our temporary
7165 breakpoints they are permanent. */
7166 cleanup = save_current_space_and_thread ();
7167
7168 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (loc->pspace);
7169 make_show_memory_breakpoints_cleanup (0);
7170
7171 if (target_read_memory (loc->address, target_mem, len) == 0
7172 && memcmp (target_mem, brk, len) == 0)
7173 retval = 1;
7174
7175 do_cleanups (cleanup);
7176
7177 return retval;
7178 }
7179
7180
7181
7182 /* Create a breakpoint with SAL as location. Use ADDR_STRING
7183 as textual description of the location, and COND_STRING
7184 as condition expression. */
7185
7186 static void
7187 create_breakpoint_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7188 struct symtabs_and_lines sals, char *addr_string,
7189 char *cond_string,
7190 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
7191 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
7192 struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
7193 int enabled, int internal)
7194 {
7195 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
7196 int i;
7197
7198 if (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7199 {
7200 int i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
7201 int target_resources_ok =
7202 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
7203 i + 1, 0);
7204 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
7205 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
7206 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
7207 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
7208 }
7209
7210 gdb_assert (sals.nelts > 0);
7211
7212 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
7213 {
7214 struct symtab_and_line sal = sals.sals[i];
7215 struct bp_location *loc;
7216
7217 if (from_tty)
7218 {
7219 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
7220 if (!loc_gdbarch)
7221 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
7222
7223 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
7224 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, thread);
7225 }
7226
7227 if (i == 0)
7228 {
7229 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type);
7230 set_breakpoint_number (internal, b);
7231 b->thread = thread;
7232 b->task = task;
7233
7234 b->cond_string = cond_string;
7235 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
7236 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
7237 b->disposition = disposition;
7238 b->pspace = sals.sals[0].pspace;
7239
7240 if (type == bp_static_tracepoint)
7241 {
7242 struct static_tracepoint_marker marker;
7243
7244 if (is_marker_spec (addr_string))
7245 {
7246 /* We already know the marker exists, otherwise, we
7247 wouldn't see a sal for it. */
7248 char *p = &addr_string[3];
7249 char *endp;
7250 char *marker_str;
7251 int i;
7252
7253 p = skip_spaces (p);
7254
7255 endp = skip_to_space (p);
7256
7257 marker_str = savestring (p, endp - p);
7258 b->static_trace_marker_id = marker_str;
7259
7260 printf_filtered (_("Probed static tracepoint "
7261 "marker \"%s\"\n"),
7262 b->static_trace_marker_id);
7263 }
7264 else if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (sal.pc, &marker))
7265 {
7266 b->static_trace_marker_id = xstrdup (marker.str_id);
7267 release_static_tracepoint_marker (&marker);
7268
7269 printf_filtered (_("Probed static tracepoint "
7270 "marker \"%s\"\n"),
7271 b->static_trace_marker_id);
7272 }
7273 else
7274 warning (_("Couldn't determine the static "
7275 "tracepoint marker to probe"));
7276 }
7277
7278 if (enabled && b->pspace->executing_startup
7279 && (b->type == bp_breakpoint
7280 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint))
7281 b->enable_state = bp_startup_disabled;
7282
7283 loc = b->loc;
7284 }
7285 else
7286 {
7287 loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
7288 }
7289
7290 if (bp_loc_is_permanent (loc))
7291 make_breakpoint_permanent (b);
7292
7293 if (b->cond_string)
7294 {
7295 char *arg = b->cond_string;
7296 loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&arg, block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
7297 if (*arg)
7298 error (_("Garbage %s follows condition"), arg);
7299 }
7300 }
7301
7302 if (addr_string)
7303 b->addr_string = addr_string;
7304 else
7305 /* addr_string has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete
7306 me. */
7307 b->addr_string
7308 = xstrprintf ("*%s", paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address));
7309
7310 b->ops = ops;
7311 if (internal)
7312 /* Do not mention breakpoints with a negative number, but do
7313 notify observers. */
7314 observer_notify_breakpoint_created (b->number);
7315 else
7316 mention (b);
7317 }
7318
7319 /* Remove element at INDEX_TO_REMOVE from SAL, shifting other
7320 elements to fill the void space. */
7321 static void
7322 remove_sal (struct symtabs_and_lines *sal, int index_to_remove)
7323 {
7324 int i = index_to_remove+1;
7325 int last_index = sal->nelts-1;
7326
7327 for (;i <= last_index; ++i)
7328 sal->sals[i-1] = sal->sals[i];
7329
7330 --(sal->nelts);
7331 }
7332
7333 /* If appropriate, obtains all sals that correspond to the same file
7334 and line as SAL, in all program spaces. Users debugging with IDEs,
7335 will want to set a breakpoint at foo.c:line, and not really care
7336 about program spaces. This is done only if SAL does not have
7337 explicit PC and has line and file information. If we got just a
7338 single expanded sal, return the original.
7339
7340 Otherwise, if SAL.explicit_line is not set, filter out all sals for
7341 which the name of enclosing function is different from SAL. This
7342 makes sure that if we have breakpoint originally set in template
7343 instantiation, say foo<int>(), we won't expand SAL to locations at
7344 the same line in all existing instantiations of 'foo'. */
7345
7346 static struct symtabs_and_lines
7347 expand_line_sal_maybe (struct symtab_and_line sal)
7348 {
7349 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded;
7350 CORE_ADDR original_pc = sal.pc;
7351 char *original_function = NULL;
7352 int found;
7353 int i;
7354 struct cleanup *old_chain;
7355
7356 /* If we have explicit pc, don't expand.
7357 If we have no line number, we can't expand. */
7358 if (sal.explicit_pc || sal.line == 0 || sal.symtab == NULL)
7359 {
7360 expanded.nelts = 1;
7361 expanded.sals = xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
7362 expanded.sals[0] = sal;
7363 return expanded;
7364 }
7365
7366 sal.pc = 0;
7367
7368 old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
7369
7370 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal.pspace);
7371
7372 find_pc_partial_function (original_pc, &original_function, NULL, NULL);
7373
7374 /* Note that expand_line_sal visits *all* program spaces. */
7375 expanded = expand_line_sal (sal);
7376
7377 if (expanded.nelts == 1)
7378 {
7379 /* We had one sal, we got one sal. Return that sal, adjusting it
7380 past the function prologue if necessary. */
7381 xfree (expanded.sals);
7382 expanded.nelts = 1;
7383 expanded.sals = xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
7384 sal.pc = original_pc;
7385 expanded.sals[0] = sal;
7386 skip_prologue_sal (&expanded.sals[0]);
7387 do_cleanups (old_chain);
7388 return expanded;
7389 }
7390
7391 if (!sal.explicit_line)
7392 {
7393 CORE_ADDR func_addr, func_end;
7394 for (i = 0; i < expanded.nelts; ++i)
7395 {
7396 CORE_ADDR pc = expanded.sals[i].pc;
7397 char *this_function;
7398
7399 /* We need to switch threads as well since we're about to
7400 read memory. */
7401 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (expanded.sals[i].pspace);
7402
7403 if (find_pc_partial_function (pc, &this_function,
7404 &func_addr, &func_end))
7405 {
7406 if (this_function
7407 && strcmp (this_function, original_function) != 0)
7408 {
7409 remove_sal (&expanded, i);
7410 --i;
7411 }
7412 }
7413 }
7414 }
7415
7416 /* Skip the function prologue if necessary. */
7417 for (i = 0; i < expanded.nelts; ++i)
7418 skip_prologue_sal (&expanded.sals[i]);
7419
7420 do_cleanups (old_chain);
7421
7422 if (expanded.nelts <= 1)
7423 {
7424 /* This is un ugly workaround. If we get zero expanded sals
7425 then something is really wrong. Fix that by returning the
7426 original sal. */
7427
7428 xfree (expanded.sals);
7429 expanded.nelts = 1;
7430 expanded.sals = xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
7431 sal.pc = original_pc;
7432 expanded.sals[0] = sal;
7433 return expanded;
7434 }
7435
7436 if (original_pc)
7437 {
7438 found = 0;
7439 for (i = 0; i < expanded.nelts; ++i)
7440 if (expanded.sals[i].pc == original_pc)
7441 {
7442 found = 1;
7443 break;
7444 }
7445 gdb_assert (found);
7446 }
7447
7448 return expanded;
7449 }
7450
7451 /* Add SALS.nelts breakpoints to the breakpoint table. For each
7452 SALS.sal[i] breakpoint, include the corresponding ADDR_STRING[i]
7453 value. COND_STRING, if not NULL, specified the condition to be
7454 used for all breakpoints. Essentially the only case where
7455 SALS.nelts is not 1 is when we set a breakpoint on an overloaded
7456 function. In that case, it's still not possible to specify
7457 separate conditions for different overloaded functions, so
7458 we take just a single condition string.
7459
7460 NOTE: If the function succeeds, the caller is expected to cleanup
7461 the arrays ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING, and SALS (but not the
7462 array contents). If the function fails (error() is called), the
7463 caller is expected to cleanups both the ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING,
7464 COND and SALS arrays and each of those arrays contents. */
7465
7466 static void
7467 create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7468 struct symtabs_and_lines sals, char **addr_string,
7469 char *cond_string,
7470 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
7471 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
7472 struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
7473 int enabled, int internal)
7474 {
7475 int i;
7476
7477 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
7478 {
7479 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded =
7480 expand_line_sal_maybe (sals.sals[i]);
7481
7482 create_breakpoint_sal (gdbarch, expanded, addr_string[i],
7483 cond_string, type, disposition,
7484 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
7485 from_tty, enabled, internal);
7486 }
7487 }
7488
7489 /* Parse ADDRESS which is assumed to be a SAL specification possibly
7490 followed by conditionals. On return, SALS contains an array of SAL
7491 addresses found. ADDR_STRING contains a vector of (canonical)
7492 address strings. ADDRESS points to the end of the SAL.
7493
7494 The array and the line spec strings are allocated on the heap, it is
7495 the caller's responsibility to free them. */
7496
7497 static void
7498 parse_breakpoint_sals (char **address,
7499 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals,
7500 char ***addr_string,
7501 int *not_found_ptr)
7502 {
7503 char *addr_start = *address;
7504
7505 *addr_string = NULL;
7506 /* If no arg given, or if first arg is 'if ', use the default
7507 breakpoint. */
7508 if ((*address) == NULL
7509 || (strncmp ((*address), "if", 2) == 0 && isspace ((*address)[2])))
7510 {
7511 if (default_breakpoint_valid)
7512 {
7513 struct symtab_and_line sal;
7514
7515 init_sal (&sal); /* Initialize to zeroes. */
7516 sals->sals = (struct symtab_and_line *)
7517 xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
7518 sal.pc = default_breakpoint_address;
7519 sal.line = default_breakpoint_line;
7520 sal.symtab = default_breakpoint_symtab;
7521 sal.pspace = default_breakpoint_pspace;
7522 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (sal.pc);
7523
7524 /* "break" without arguments is equivalent to "break *PC"
7525 where PC is the default_breakpoint_address. So make sure
7526 to set sal.explicit_pc to prevent GDB from trying to
7527 expand the list of sals to include all other instances
7528 with the same symtab and line. */
7529 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
7530
7531 sals->sals[0] = sal;
7532 sals->nelts = 1;
7533 }
7534 else
7535 error (_("No default breakpoint address now."));
7536 }
7537 else
7538 {
7539 /* Force almost all breakpoints to be in terms of the
7540 current_source_symtab (which is decode_line_1's default).
7541 This should produce the results we want almost all of the
7542 time while leaving default_breakpoint_* alone.
7543
7544 ObjC: However, don't match an Objective-C method name which
7545 may have a '+' or '-' succeeded by a '[' */
7546
7547 struct symtab_and_line cursal = get_current_source_symtab_and_line ();
7548
7549 if (default_breakpoint_valid
7550 && (!cursal.symtab
7551 || ((strchr ("+-", (*address)[0]) != NULL)
7552 && ((*address)[1] != '['))))
7553 *sals = decode_line_1 (address, 1, default_breakpoint_symtab,
7554 default_breakpoint_line, addr_string,
7555 not_found_ptr);
7556 else
7557 *sals = decode_line_1 (address, 1, (struct symtab *) NULL, 0,
7558 addr_string, not_found_ptr);
7559 }
7560 /* For any SAL that didn't have a canonical string, fill one in. */
7561 if (sals->nelts > 0 && *addr_string == NULL)
7562 *addr_string = xcalloc (sals->nelts, sizeof (char **));
7563 if (addr_start != (*address))
7564 {
7565 int i;
7566
7567 for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++)
7568 {
7569 /* Add the string if not present. */
7570 if ((*addr_string)[i] == NULL)
7571 (*addr_string)[i] = savestring (addr_start,
7572 (*address) - addr_start);
7573 }
7574 }
7575 }
7576
7577
7578 /* Convert each SAL into a real PC. Verify that the PC can be
7579 inserted as a breakpoint. If it can't throw an error. */
7580
7581 static void
7582 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
7583 {
7584 int i;
7585
7586 for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++)
7587 resolve_sal_pc (&sals->sals[i]);
7588 }
7589
7590 /* Fast tracepoints may have restrictions on valid locations. For
7591 instance, a fast tracepoint using a jump instead of a trap will
7592 likely have to overwrite more bytes than a trap would, and so can
7593 only be placed where the instruction is longer than the jump, or a
7594 multi-instruction sequence does not have a jump into the middle of
7595 it, etc. */
7596
7597 static void
7598 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7599 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
7600 {
7601 int i, rslt;
7602 struct symtab_and_line *sal;
7603 char *msg;
7604 struct cleanup *old_chain;
7605
7606 for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++)
7607 {
7608 sal = &sals->sals[i];
7609
7610 rslt = gdbarch_fast_tracepoint_valid_at (gdbarch, sal->pc,
7611 NULL, &msg);
7612 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, msg);
7613
7614 if (!rslt)
7615 error (_("May not have a fast tracepoint at 0x%s%s"),
7616 paddress (gdbarch, sal->pc), (msg ? msg : ""));
7617
7618 do_cleanups (old_chain);
7619 }
7620 }
7621
7622 static void
7623 do_captured_parse_breakpoint (struct ui_out *ui, void *data)
7624 {
7625 struct captured_parse_breakpoint_args *args = data;
7626
7627 parse_breakpoint_sals (args->arg_p, args->sals_p, args->addr_string_p,
7628 args->not_found_ptr);
7629 }
7630
7631 /* Given TOK, a string specification of condition and thread, as
7632 accepted by the 'break' command, extract the condition
7633 string and thread number and set *COND_STRING and *THREAD.
7634 PC identifies the context at which the condition should be parsed.
7635 If no condition is found, *COND_STRING is set to NULL.
7636 If no thread is found, *THREAD is set to -1. */
7637 static void
7638 find_condition_and_thread (char *tok, CORE_ADDR pc,
7639 char **cond_string, int *thread, int *task)
7640 {
7641 *cond_string = NULL;
7642 *thread = -1;
7643 while (tok && *tok)
7644 {
7645 char *end_tok;
7646 int toklen;
7647 char *cond_start = NULL;
7648 char *cond_end = NULL;
7649
7650 tok = skip_spaces (tok);
7651
7652 end_tok = skip_to_space (tok);
7653
7654 toklen = end_tok - tok;
7655
7656 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
7657 {
7658 struct expression *expr;
7659
7660 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
7661 expr = parse_exp_1 (&tok, block_for_pc (pc), 0);
7662 xfree (expr);
7663 cond_end = tok;
7664 *cond_string = savestring (cond_start,
7665 cond_end - cond_start);
7666 }
7667 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "thread", toklen) == 0)
7668 {
7669 char *tmptok;
7670
7671 tok = end_tok + 1;
7672 tmptok = tok;
7673 *thread = strtol (tok, &tok, 0);
7674 if (tok == tmptok)
7675 error (_("Junk after thread keyword."));
7676 if (!valid_thread_id (*thread))
7677 error (_("Unknown thread %d."), *thread);
7678 }
7679 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "task", toklen) == 0)
7680 {
7681 char *tmptok;
7682
7683 tok = end_tok + 1;
7684 tmptok = tok;
7685 *task = strtol (tok, &tok, 0);
7686 if (tok == tmptok)
7687 error (_("Junk after task keyword."));
7688 if (!valid_task_id (*task))
7689 error (_("Unknown task %d."), *task);
7690 }
7691 else
7692 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
7693 }
7694 }
7695
7696 /* Decode a static tracepoint marker spec. */
7697
7698 static struct symtabs_and_lines
7699 decode_static_tracepoint_spec (char **arg_p)
7700 {
7701 VEC(static_tracepoint_marker_p) *markers = NULL;
7702 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
7703 struct symtab_and_line sal;
7704 struct symbol *sym;
7705 struct cleanup *old_chain;
7706 char *p = &(*arg_p)[3];
7707 char *endp;
7708 char *marker_str;
7709 int i;
7710
7711 p = skip_spaces (p);
7712
7713 endp = skip_to_space (p);
7714
7715 marker_str = savestring (p, endp - p);
7716 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, marker_str);
7717
7718 markers = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid (marker_str);
7719 if (VEC_empty(static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers))
7720 error (_("No known static tracepoint marker named %s"), marker_str);
7721
7722 sals.nelts = VEC_length(static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers);
7723 sals.sals = xmalloc (sizeof *sals.sals * sals.nelts);
7724
7725 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; i++)
7726 {
7727 struct static_tracepoint_marker *marker;
7728
7729 marker = VEC_index (static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers, i);
7730
7731 init_sal (&sals.sals[i]);
7732
7733 sals.sals[i] = find_pc_line (marker->address, 0);
7734 sals.sals[i].pc = marker->address;
7735
7736 release_static_tracepoint_marker (marker);
7737 }
7738
7739 do_cleanups (old_chain);
7740
7741 *arg_p = endp;
7742 return sals;
7743 }
7744
7745 /* Set a breakpoint. This function is shared between CLI and MI
7746 functions for setting a breakpoint. This function has two major
7747 modes of operations, selected by the PARSE_CONDITION_AND_THREAD
7748 parameter. If non-zero, the function will parse arg, extracting
7749 breakpoint location, address and thread. Otherwise, ARG is just
7750 the location of breakpoint, with condition and thread specified by
7751 the COND_STRING and THREAD parameters. If INTERNAL is non-zero,
7752 the breakpoint number will be allocated from the internal
7753 breakpoint count. Returns true if any breakpoint was created;
7754 false otherwise. */
7755
7756 int
7757 create_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7758 char *arg, char *cond_string, int thread,
7759 int parse_condition_and_thread,
7760 int tempflag, enum bptype type_wanted,
7761 int ignore_count,
7762 enum auto_boolean pending_break_support,
7763 struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
7764 int from_tty, int enabled, int internal)
7765 {
7766 struct gdb_exception e;
7767 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
7768 struct symtab_and_line pending_sal;
7769 char *copy_arg;
7770 char *addr_start = arg;
7771 char **addr_string;
7772 struct cleanup *old_chain;
7773 struct cleanup *bkpt_chain = NULL;
7774 struct captured_parse_breakpoint_args parse_args;
7775 int i;
7776 int pending = 0;
7777 int not_found = 0;
7778 int task = 0;
7779 int prev_bkpt_count = breakpoint_count;
7780
7781 sals.sals = NULL;
7782 sals.nelts = 0;
7783 addr_string = NULL;
7784
7785 parse_args.arg_p = &arg;
7786 parse_args.sals_p = &sals;
7787 parse_args.addr_string_p = &addr_string;
7788 parse_args.not_found_ptr = &not_found;
7789
7790 if (type_wanted == bp_static_tracepoint && is_marker_spec (arg))
7791 {
7792 int i;
7793
7794 sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (&arg);
7795
7796 copy_arg = savestring (addr_start, arg - addr_start);
7797 addr_string = xcalloc (sals.nelts, sizeof (char **));
7798 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; i++)
7799 addr_string[i] = xstrdup (copy_arg);
7800 goto done;
7801 }
7802
7803 e = catch_exception (uiout, do_captured_parse_breakpoint,
7804 &parse_args, RETURN_MASK_ALL);
7805
7806 /* If caller is interested in rc value from parse, set value. */
7807 switch (e.reason)
7808 {
7809 case RETURN_QUIT:
7810 throw_exception (e);
7811 case RETURN_ERROR:
7812 switch (e.error)
7813 {
7814 case NOT_FOUND_ERROR:
7815
7816 /* If pending breakpoint support is turned off, throw
7817 error. */
7818
7819 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE)
7820 throw_exception (e);
7821
7822 exception_print (gdb_stderr, e);
7823
7824 /* If pending breakpoint support is auto query and the user
7825 selects no, then simply return the error code. */
7826 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO
7827 && !nquery (_("Make breakpoint pending on "
7828 "future shared library load? ")))
7829 return 0;
7830
7831 /* At this point, either the user was queried about setting
7832 a pending breakpoint and selected yes, or pending
7833 breakpoint behavior is on and thus a pending breakpoint
7834 is defaulted on behalf of the user. */
7835 copy_arg = xstrdup (addr_start);
7836 addr_string = &copy_arg;
7837 sals.nelts = 1;
7838 sals.sals = &pending_sal;
7839 pending_sal.pc = 0;
7840 pending = 1;
7841 break;
7842 default:
7843 throw_exception (e);
7844 }
7845 break;
7846 default:
7847 if (!sals.nelts)
7848 return 0;
7849 }
7850
7851 done:
7852
7853 /* Create a chain of things that always need to be cleaned up. */
7854 old_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, 0);
7855
7856 if (!pending)
7857 {
7858 /* Make sure that all storage allocated to SALS gets freed. */
7859 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
7860
7861 /* Cleanup the addr_string array but not its contents. */
7862 make_cleanup (xfree, addr_string);
7863 }
7864
7865 /* ----------------------------- SNIP -----------------------------
7866 Anything added to the cleanup chain beyond this point is assumed
7867 to be part of a breakpoint. If the breakpoint create succeeds
7868 then the memory is not reclaimed. */
7869 bkpt_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, 0);
7870
7871 /* Mark the contents of the addr_string for cleanup. These go on
7872 the bkpt_chain and only occur if the breakpoint create fails. */
7873 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; i++)
7874 {
7875 if (addr_string[i] != NULL)
7876 make_cleanup (xfree, addr_string[i]);
7877 }
7878
7879 /* Resolve all line numbers to PC's and verify that the addresses
7880 are ok for the target. */
7881 if (!pending)
7882 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (&sals);
7883
7884 /* Fast tracepoints may have additional restrictions on location. */
7885 if (type_wanted == bp_fast_tracepoint)
7886 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (gdbarch, &sals);
7887
7888 /* Verify that condition can be parsed, before setting any
7889 breakpoints. Allocate a separate condition expression for each
7890 breakpoint. */
7891 if (!pending)
7892 {
7893 if (parse_condition_and_thread)
7894 {
7895 /* Here we only parse 'arg' to separate condition
7896 from thread number, so parsing in context of first
7897 sal is OK. When setting the breakpoint we'll
7898 re-parse it in context of each sal. */
7899 cond_string = NULL;
7900 thread = -1;
7901 find_condition_and_thread (arg, sals.sals[0].pc, &cond_string,
7902 &thread, &task);
7903 if (cond_string)
7904 make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string);
7905 }
7906 else
7907 {
7908 /* Create a private copy of condition string. */
7909 if (cond_string)
7910 {
7911 cond_string = xstrdup (cond_string);
7912 make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string);
7913 }
7914 }
7915
7916 /* If the user is creating a static tracepoint by marker id
7917 (strace -m MARKER_ID), then store the sals index, so that
7918 breakpoint_re_set can try to match up which of the newly
7919 found markers corresponds to this one, and, don't try to
7920 expand multiple locations for each sal, given than SALS
7921 already should contain all sals for MARKER_ID. */
7922 if (type_wanted == bp_static_tracepoint
7923 && is_marker_spec (addr_string[0]))
7924 {
7925 int i;
7926
7927 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
7928 {
7929 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded;
7930 struct breakpoint *tp;
7931 struct cleanup *old_chain;
7932
7933 expanded.nelts = 1;
7934 expanded.sals = xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
7935 expanded.sals[0] = sals.sals[i];
7936 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, expanded.sals);
7937
7938 create_breakpoint_sal (gdbarch, expanded, addr_string[i],
7939 cond_string, type_wanted,
7940 tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch,
7941 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
7942 from_tty, enabled, internal);
7943
7944 do_cleanups (old_chain);
7945
7946 /* Get the tracepoint we just created. */
7947 if (internal)
7948 tp = get_breakpoint (internal_breakpoint_number);
7949 else
7950 tp = get_breakpoint (breakpoint_count);
7951 gdb_assert (tp != NULL);
7952
7953 /* Given that its possible to have multiple markers with
7954 the same string id, if the user is creating a static
7955 tracepoint by marker id ("strace -m MARKER_ID"), then
7956 store the sals index, so that breakpoint_re_set can
7957 try to match up which of the newly found markers
7958 corresponds to this one */
7959 tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx = i;
7960 }
7961 }
7962 else
7963 create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch, sals, addr_string, cond_string,
7964 type_wanted,
7965 tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch,
7966 thread, task, ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
7967 enabled, internal);
7968 }
7969 else
7970 {
7971 struct breakpoint *b;
7972
7973 make_cleanup (xfree, copy_arg);
7974
7975 b = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (gdbarch, type_wanted);
7976 set_breakpoint_number (internal, b);
7977 b->thread = -1;
7978 b->addr_string = addr_string[0];
7979 b->cond_string = NULL;
7980 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
7981 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
7982 b->condition_not_parsed = 1;
7983 b->ops = ops;
7984 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
7985 b->pspace = current_program_space;
7986 b->py_bp_object = NULL;
7987
7988 if (enabled && b->pspace->executing_startup
7989 && (b->type == bp_breakpoint
7990 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint))
7991 b->enable_state = bp_startup_disabled;
7992
7993 if (internal)
7994 /* Do not mention breakpoints with a negative number,
7995 but do notify observers. */
7996 observer_notify_breakpoint_created (b->number);
7997 else
7998 mention (b);
7999 }
8000
8001 if (sals.nelts > 1)
8002 {
8003 warning (_("Multiple breakpoints were set.\nUse the "
8004 "\"delete\" command to delete unwanted breakpoints."));
8005 prev_breakpoint_count = prev_bkpt_count;
8006 }
8007
8008 /* That's it. Discard the cleanups for data inserted into the
8009 breakpoint. */
8010 discard_cleanups (bkpt_chain);
8011 /* But cleanup everything else. */
8012 do_cleanups (old_chain);
8013
8014 /* error call may happen here - have BKPT_CHAIN already discarded. */
8015 update_global_location_list (1);
8016
8017 return 1;
8018 }
8019
8020 /* Set a breakpoint.
8021 ARG is a string describing breakpoint address,
8022 condition, and thread.
8023 FLAG specifies if a breakpoint is hardware on,
8024 and if breakpoint is temporary, using BP_HARDWARE_FLAG
8025 and BP_TEMPFLAG. */
8026
8027 static void
8028 break_command_1 (char *arg, int flag, int from_tty)
8029 {
8030 int tempflag = flag & BP_TEMPFLAG;
8031 enum bptype type_wanted = (flag & BP_HARDWAREFLAG
8032 ? bp_hardware_breakpoint
8033 : bp_breakpoint);
8034
8035 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
8036 arg,
8037 NULL, 0, 1 /* parse arg */,
8038 tempflag, type_wanted,
8039 0 /* Ignore count */,
8040 pending_break_support,
8041 NULL /* breakpoint_ops */,
8042 from_tty,
8043 1 /* enabled */,
8044 0 /* internal */);
8045 }
8046
8047
8048 /* Helper function for break_command_1 and disassemble_command. */
8049
8050 void
8051 resolve_sal_pc (struct symtab_and_line *sal)
8052 {
8053 CORE_ADDR pc;
8054
8055 if (sal->pc == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
8056 {
8057 if (!find_line_pc (sal->symtab, sal->line, &pc))
8058 error (_("No line %d in file \"%s\"."),
8059 sal->line, sal->symtab->filename);
8060 sal->pc = pc;
8061
8062 /* If this SAL corresponds to a breakpoint inserted using a line
8063 number, then skip the function prologue if necessary. */
8064 if (sal->explicit_line)
8065 skip_prologue_sal (sal);
8066 }
8067
8068 if (sal->section == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
8069 {
8070 struct blockvector *bv;
8071 struct block *b;
8072 struct symbol *sym;
8073
8074 bv = blockvector_for_pc_sect (sal->pc, 0, &b, sal->symtab);
8075 if (bv != NULL)
8076 {
8077 sym = block_linkage_function (b);
8078 if (sym != NULL)
8079 {
8080 fixup_symbol_section (sym, sal->symtab->objfile);
8081 sal->section = SYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (sym);
8082 }
8083 else
8084 {
8085 /* It really is worthwhile to have the section, so we'll
8086 just have to look harder. This case can be executed
8087 if we have line numbers but no functions (as can
8088 happen in assembly source). */
8089
8090 struct minimal_symbol *msym;
8091 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
8092
8093 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal->pspace);
8094
8095 msym = lookup_minimal_symbol_by_pc (sal->pc);
8096 if (msym)
8097 sal->section = SYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (msym);
8098
8099 do_cleanups (old_chain);
8100 }
8101 }
8102 }
8103 }
8104
8105 void
8106 break_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8107 {
8108 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
8109 }
8110
8111 void
8112 tbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8113 {
8114 break_command_1 (arg, BP_TEMPFLAG, from_tty);
8115 }
8116
8117 static void
8118 hbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8119 {
8120 break_command_1 (arg, BP_HARDWAREFLAG, from_tty);
8121 }
8122
8123 static void
8124 thbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8125 {
8126 break_command_1 (arg, (BP_TEMPFLAG | BP_HARDWAREFLAG), from_tty);
8127 }
8128
8129 static void
8130 stop_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8131 {
8132 printf_filtered (_("Specify the type of breakpoint to set.\n\
8133 Usage: stop in <function | address>\n\
8134 stop at <line>\n"));
8135 }
8136
8137 static void
8138 stopin_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8139 {
8140 int badInput = 0;
8141
8142 if (arg == (char *) NULL)
8143 badInput = 1;
8144 else if (*arg != '*')
8145 {
8146 char *argptr = arg;
8147 int hasColon = 0;
8148
8149 /* Look for a ':'. If this is a line number specification, then
8150 say it is bad, otherwise, it should be an address or
8151 function/method name. */
8152 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
8153 {
8154 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
8155 argptr++;
8156 }
8157
8158 if (hasColon)
8159 badInput = (*argptr != ':'); /* Not a class::method */
8160 else
8161 badInput = isdigit (*arg); /* a simple line number */
8162 }
8163
8164 if (badInput)
8165 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop in <function | address>\n"));
8166 else
8167 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
8168 }
8169
8170 static void
8171 stopat_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8172 {
8173 int badInput = 0;
8174
8175 if (arg == (char *) NULL || *arg == '*') /* no line number */
8176 badInput = 1;
8177 else
8178 {
8179 char *argptr = arg;
8180 int hasColon = 0;
8181
8182 /* Look for a ':'. If there is a '::' then get out, otherwise
8183 it is probably a line number. */
8184 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
8185 {
8186 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
8187 argptr++;
8188 }
8189
8190 if (hasColon)
8191 badInput = (*argptr == ':'); /* we have class::method */
8192 else
8193 badInput = !isdigit (*arg); /* not a line number */
8194 }
8195
8196 if (badInput)
8197 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop at <line>\n"));
8198 else
8199 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
8200 }
8201
8202 /* Return non-zero if EXP is verified as constant. Returned zero
8203 means EXP is variable. Also the constant detection may fail for
8204 some constant expressions and in such case still falsely return
8205 zero. */
8206 static int
8207 watchpoint_exp_is_const (const struct expression *exp)
8208 {
8209 int i = exp->nelts;
8210
8211 while (i > 0)
8212 {
8213 int oplenp, argsp;
8214
8215 /* We are only interested in the descriptor of each element. */
8216 operator_length (exp, i, &oplenp, &argsp);
8217 i -= oplenp;
8218
8219 switch (exp->elts[i].opcode)
8220 {
8221 case BINOP_ADD:
8222 case BINOP_SUB:
8223 case BINOP_MUL:
8224 case BINOP_DIV:
8225 case BINOP_REM:
8226 case BINOP_MOD:
8227 case BINOP_LSH:
8228 case BINOP_RSH:
8229 case BINOP_LOGICAL_AND:
8230 case BINOP_LOGICAL_OR:
8231 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
8232 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
8233 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
8234 case BINOP_EQUAL:
8235 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
8236 case BINOP_LESS:
8237 case BINOP_GTR:
8238 case BINOP_LEQ:
8239 case BINOP_GEQ:
8240 case BINOP_REPEAT:
8241 case BINOP_COMMA:
8242 case BINOP_EXP:
8243 case BINOP_MIN:
8244 case BINOP_MAX:
8245 case BINOP_INTDIV:
8246 case BINOP_CONCAT:
8247 case BINOP_IN:
8248 case BINOP_RANGE:
8249 case TERNOP_COND:
8250 case TERNOP_SLICE:
8251 case TERNOP_SLICE_COUNT:
8252
8253 case OP_LONG:
8254 case OP_DOUBLE:
8255 case OP_DECFLOAT:
8256 case OP_LAST:
8257 case OP_COMPLEX:
8258 case OP_STRING:
8259 case OP_BITSTRING:
8260 case OP_ARRAY:
8261 case OP_TYPE:
8262 case OP_NAME:
8263 case OP_OBJC_NSSTRING:
8264
8265 case UNOP_NEG:
8266 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
8267 case UNOP_COMPLEMENT:
8268 case UNOP_ADDR:
8269 case UNOP_HIGH:
8270 /* Unary, binary and ternary operators: We have to check
8271 their operands. If they are constant, then so is the
8272 result of that operation. For instance, if A and B are
8273 determined to be constants, then so is "A + B".
8274
8275 UNOP_IND is one exception to the rule above, because the
8276 value of *ADDR is not necessarily a constant, even when
8277 ADDR is. */
8278 break;
8279
8280 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
8281 /* Check whether the associated symbol is a constant.
8282
8283 We use SYMBOL_CLASS rather than TYPE_CONST because it's
8284 possible that a buggy compiler could mark a variable as
8285 constant even when it is not, and TYPE_CONST would return
8286 true in this case, while SYMBOL_CLASS wouldn't.
8287
8288 We also have to check for function symbols because they
8289 are always constant. */
8290 {
8291 struct symbol *s = exp->elts[i + 2].symbol;
8292
8293 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_BLOCK
8294 && SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_CONST
8295 && SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_CONST_BYTES)
8296 return 0;
8297 break;
8298 }
8299
8300 /* The default action is to return 0 because we are using
8301 the optimistic approach here: If we don't know something,
8302 then it is not a constant. */
8303 default:
8304 return 0;
8305 }
8306 }
8307
8308 return 1;
8309 }
8310
8311 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for hardware watchpoints. */
8312
8313 static int
8314 insert_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
8315 {
8316 int length = bl->owner->exact? 1 : bl->length;
8317
8318 return target_insert_watchpoint (bl->address, length, bl->watchpoint_type,
8319 bl->owner->cond_exp);
8320 }
8321
8322 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for hardware watchpoints. */
8323
8324 static int
8325 remove_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
8326 {
8327 int length = bl->owner->exact? 1 : bl->length;
8328
8329 return target_remove_watchpoint (bl->address, length, bl->watchpoint_type,
8330 bl->owner->cond_exp);
8331 }
8332
8333 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
8334 hardware watchpoints. */
8335
8336 static int
8337 resources_needed_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
8338 {
8339 int length = bl->owner->exact? 1 : bl->length;
8340
8341 return target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (bl->address, length);
8342 }
8343
8344 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in hardware watchpoints. */
8345
8346 static struct breakpoint_ops watchpoint_breakpoint_ops =
8347 {
8348 insert_watchpoint,
8349 remove_watchpoint,
8350 NULL, /* breakpoint_hit */
8351 resources_needed_watchpoint,
8352 NULL, /* print_it */
8353 NULL, /* print_one */
8354 NULL, /* print_mention */
8355 NULL /* print_recreate */
8356 };
8357
8358 /* accessflag: hw_write: watch write,
8359 hw_read: watch read,
8360 hw_access: watch access (read or write) */
8361 static void
8362 watch_command_1 (char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty,
8363 int just_location, int internal)
8364 {
8365 struct breakpoint *b, *scope_breakpoint = NULL;
8366 struct expression *exp;
8367 struct block *exp_valid_block = NULL, *cond_exp_valid_block = NULL;
8368 struct value *val, *mark, *result;
8369 struct frame_info *frame;
8370 char *exp_start = NULL;
8371 char *exp_end = NULL;
8372 char *tok, *id_tok_start, *end_tok;
8373 int toklen;
8374 char *cond_start = NULL;
8375 char *cond_end = NULL;
8376 int i, other_type_used, target_resources_ok = 0;
8377 enum bptype bp_type;
8378 int reg_cnt = 0;
8379 int thread = -1;
8380 int pc = 0;
8381
8382 /* Make sure that we actually have parameters to parse. */
8383 if (arg != NULL && arg[0] != '\0')
8384 {
8385 toklen = strlen (arg); /* Size of argument list. */
8386
8387 /* Points tok to the end of the argument list. */
8388 tok = arg + toklen - 1;
8389
8390 /* Go backwards in the parameters list. Skip the last
8391 parameter. If we're expecting a 'thread <thread_num>'
8392 parameter, this should be the thread identifier. */
8393 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
8394 tok--;
8395 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
8396 tok--;
8397
8398 /* Points end_tok to the beginning of the last token. */
8399 id_tok_start = tok + 1;
8400
8401 /* Go backwards in the parameters list. Skip one more
8402 parameter. If we're expecting a 'thread <thread_num>'
8403 parameter, we should reach a "thread" token. */
8404 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
8405 tok--;
8406
8407 end_tok = tok;
8408
8409 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
8410 tok--;
8411
8412 /* Move the pointer forward to skip the whitespace and
8413 calculate the length of the token. */
8414 tok++;
8415 toklen = end_tok - tok;
8416
8417 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "thread", toklen) == 0)
8418 {
8419 /* At this point we've found a "thread" token, which means
8420 the user is trying to set a watchpoint that triggers
8421 only in a specific thread. */
8422 char *endp;
8423
8424 /* Extract the thread ID from the next token. */
8425 thread = strtol (id_tok_start, &endp, 0);
8426
8427 /* Check if the user provided a valid numeric value for the
8428 thread ID. */
8429 if (*endp != ' ' && *endp != '\t' && *endp != '\0')
8430 error (_("Invalid thread ID specification %s."), id_tok_start);
8431
8432 /* Check if the thread actually exists. */
8433 if (!valid_thread_id (thread))
8434 error (_("Unknown thread %d."), thread);
8435
8436 /* Truncate the string and get rid of the thread <thread_num>
8437 parameter before the parameter list is parsed by the
8438 evaluate_expression() function. */
8439 *tok = '\0';
8440 }
8441 }
8442
8443 /* Parse the rest of the arguments. */
8444 innermost_block = NULL;
8445 exp_start = arg;
8446 exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0);
8447 exp_end = arg;
8448 /* Remove trailing whitespace from the expression before saving it.
8449 This makes the eventual display of the expression string a bit
8450 prettier. */
8451 while (exp_end > exp_start && (exp_end[-1] == ' ' || exp_end[-1] == '\t'))
8452 --exp_end;
8453
8454 /* Checking if the expression is not constant. */
8455 if (watchpoint_exp_is_const (exp))
8456 {
8457 int len;
8458
8459 len = exp_end - exp_start;
8460 while (len > 0 && isspace (exp_start[len - 1]))
8461 len--;
8462 error (_("Cannot watch constant value `%.*s'."), len, exp_start);
8463 }
8464
8465 exp_valid_block = innermost_block;
8466 mark = value_mark ();
8467 fetch_subexp_value (exp, &pc, &val, &result, NULL);
8468
8469 if (just_location)
8470 {
8471 exp_valid_block = NULL;
8472 val = value_addr (result);
8473 release_value (val);
8474 value_free_to_mark (mark);
8475 }
8476 else if (val != NULL)
8477 release_value (val);
8478
8479 tok = skip_spaces (arg);
8480 end_tok = skip_to_space (tok);
8481
8482 toklen = end_tok - tok;
8483 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
8484 {
8485 struct expression *cond;
8486
8487 innermost_block = NULL;
8488 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
8489 cond = parse_exp_1 (&tok, 0, 0);
8490
8491 /* The watchpoint expression may not be local, but the condition
8492 may still be. E.g.: `watch global if local > 0'. */
8493 cond_exp_valid_block = innermost_block;
8494
8495 xfree (cond);
8496 cond_end = tok;
8497 }
8498 if (*tok)
8499 error (_("Junk at end of command."));
8500
8501 if (accessflag == hw_read)
8502 bp_type = bp_read_watchpoint;
8503 else if (accessflag == hw_access)
8504 bp_type = bp_access_watchpoint;
8505 else
8506 bp_type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
8507
8508 reg_cnt = can_use_hardware_watchpoint (val, target_exact_watchpoints);
8509 if (reg_cnt == 0 && bp_type != bp_hardware_watchpoint)
8510 error (_("Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint."));
8511 if (reg_cnt != 0)
8512 {
8513 i = hw_watchpoint_used_count (bp_type, &other_type_used);
8514 target_resources_ok =
8515 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_type, i + reg_cnt,
8516 other_type_used);
8517 if (target_resources_ok == 0 && bp_type != bp_hardware_watchpoint)
8518 error (_("Target does not support this type of hardware watchpoint."));
8519
8520 if (target_resources_ok < 0 && bp_type != bp_hardware_watchpoint)
8521 error (_("Target can only support one kind "
8522 "of HW watchpoint at a time."));
8523 }
8524
8525 /* Change the type of breakpoint to an ordinary watchpoint if a
8526 hardware watchpoint could not be set. */
8527 if (!reg_cnt || target_resources_ok <= 0)
8528 bp_type = bp_watchpoint;
8529
8530 frame = block_innermost_frame (exp_valid_block);
8531
8532 /* If the expression is "local", then set up a "watchpoint scope"
8533 breakpoint at the point where we've left the scope of the watchpoint
8534 expression. Create the scope breakpoint before the watchpoint, so
8535 that we will encounter it first in bpstat_stop_status. */
8536 if (exp_valid_block && frame)
8537 {
8538 if (frame_id_p (frame_unwind_caller_id (frame)))
8539 {
8540 scope_breakpoint
8541 = create_internal_breakpoint (frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame),
8542 frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame),
8543 bp_watchpoint_scope);
8544
8545 scope_breakpoint->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8546
8547 /* Automatically delete the breakpoint when it hits. */
8548 scope_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del;
8549
8550 /* Only break in the proper frame (help with recursion). */
8551 scope_breakpoint->frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (frame);
8552
8553 /* Set the address at which we will stop. */
8554 scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch
8555 = frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame);
8556 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address
8557 = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
8558 scope_breakpoint->loc->address
8559 = adjust_breakpoint_address (scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch,
8560 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address,
8561 scope_breakpoint->type);
8562 }
8563 }
8564
8565 /* Now set up the breakpoint. */
8566 b = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (NULL, bp_type);
8567 set_breakpoint_number (internal, b);
8568 b->thread = thread;
8569 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
8570 b->exp = exp;
8571 b->exp_valid_block = exp_valid_block;
8572 b->cond_exp_valid_block = cond_exp_valid_block;
8573 if (just_location)
8574 {
8575 struct type *t = value_type (val);
8576 CORE_ADDR addr = value_as_address (val);
8577 char *name;
8578
8579 t = check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (check_typedef (t)));
8580 name = type_to_string (t);
8581
8582 b->exp_string_reparse = xstrprintf ("* (%s *) %s", name,
8583 core_addr_to_string (addr));
8584 xfree (name);
8585
8586 b->exp_string = xstrprintf ("-location: %.*s",
8587 (int) (exp_end - exp_start), exp_start);
8588
8589 /* The above expression is in C. */
8590 b->language = language_c;
8591 }
8592 else
8593 b->exp_string = savestring (exp_start, exp_end - exp_start);
8594 b->val = val;
8595 b->val_valid = 1;
8596 b->ops = &watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
8597
8598 /* Use an exact watchpoint when there's only one memory region to be
8599 watched, and only one debug register is needed to watch it. */
8600 b->exact = target_exact_watchpoints && reg_cnt == 1;
8601
8602 if (cond_start)
8603 b->cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start);
8604 else
8605 b->cond_string = 0;
8606
8607 if (frame)
8608 {
8609 b->watchpoint_frame = get_frame_id (frame);
8610 b->watchpoint_thread = inferior_ptid;
8611 }
8612 else
8613 {
8614 b->watchpoint_frame = null_frame_id;
8615 b->watchpoint_thread = null_ptid;
8616 }
8617
8618 if (scope_breakpoint != NULL)
8619 {
8620 /* The scope breakpoint is related to the watchpoint. We will
8621 need to act on them together. */
8622 b->related_breakpoint = scope_breakpoint;
8623 scope_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = b;
8624 }
8625
8626 if (!just_location)
8627 value_free_to_mark (mark);
8628
8629 /* Finally update the new watchpoint. This creates the locations
8630 that should be inserted. */
8631 update_watchpoint (b, 1);
8632 if (internal)
8633 /* Do not mention breakpoints with a negative number, but do
8634 notify observers. */
8635 observer_notify_breakpoint_created (b->number);
8636 else
8637 mention (b);
8638 update_global_location_list (1);
8639 }
8640
8641 /* Return count of debug registers needed to watch the given expression.
8642 If EXACT_WATCHPOINTS is 1, then consider that only the address of
8643 the start of the watched region will be monitored (i.e., all accesses
8644 will be aligned). This uses less debug registers on some targets.
8645
8646 If the watchpoint cannot be handled in hardware return zero. */
8647
8648 static int
8649 can_use_hardware_watchpoint (struct value *v, int exact_watchpoints)
8650 {
8651 int found_memory_cnt = 0;
8652 struct value *head = v;
8653
8654 /* Did the user specifically forbid us to use hardware watchpoints? */
8655 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
8656 return 0;
8657
8658 /* Make sure that the value of the expression depends only upon
8659 memory contents, and values computed from them within GDB. If we
8660 find any register references or function calls, we can't use a
8661 hardware watchpoint.
8662
8663 The idea here is that evaluating an expression generates a series
8664 of values, one holding the value of every subexpression. (The
8665 expression a*b+c has five subexpressions: a, b, a*b, c, and
8666 a*b+c.) GDB's values hold almost enough information to establish
8667 the criteria given above --- they identify memory lvalues,
8668 register lvalues, computed values, etcetera. So we can evaluate
8669 the expression, and then scan the chain of values that leaves
8670 behind to decide whether we can detect any possible change to the
8671 expression's final value using only hardware watchpoints.
8672
8673 However, I don't think that the values returned by inferior
8674 function calls are special in any way. So this function may not
8675 notice that an expression involving an inferior function call
8676 can't be watched with hardware watchpoints. FIXME. */
8677 for (; v; v = value_next (v))
8678 {
8679 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory)
8680 {
8681 if (v != head && value_lazy (v))
8682 /* A lazy memory lvalue in the chain is one that GDB never
8683 needed to fetch; we either just used its address (e.g.,
8684 `a' in `a.b') or we never needed it at all (e.g., `a'
8685 in `a,b'). This doesn't apply to HEAD; if that is
8686 lazy then it was not readable, but watch it anyway. */
8687 ;
8688 else
8689 {
8690 /* Ahh, memory we actually used! Check if we can cover
8691 it with hardware watchpoints. */
8692 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
8693
8694 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked for it
8695 explicitly, never if they just happen to appear in a
8696 middle of some value chain. */
8697 if (v == head
8698 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
8699 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
8700 {
8701 CORE_ADDR vaddr = value_address (v);
8702 int len;
8703 int num_regs;
8704
8705 len = (exact_watchpoints
8706 && is_scalar_type_recursive (vtype))?
8707 1 : TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
8708
8709 num_regs = target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (vaddr, len);
8710 if (!num_regs)
8711 return 0;
8712 else
8713 found_memory_cnt += num_regs;
8714 }
8715 }
8716 }
8717 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) != not_lval
8718 && deprecated_value_modifiable (v) == 0)
8719 return 0; /* These are values from the history (e.g., $1). */
8720 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_register)
8721 return 0; /* Cannot watch a register with a HW watchpoint. */
8722 }
8723
8724 /* The expression itself looks suitable for using a hardware
8725 watchpoint, but give the target machine a chance to reject it. */
8726 return found_memory_cnt;
8727 }
8728
8729 void
8730 watch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
8731 {
8732 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_write, from_tty, 0, internal);
8733 }
8734
8735 /* A helper function that looks for an argument at the start of a
8736 string. The argument must also either be at the end of the string,
8737 or be followed by whitespace. Returns 1 if it finds the argument,
8738 0 otherwise. If the argument is found, it updates *STR. */
8739
8740 static int
8741 check_for_argument (char **str, char *arg, int arg_len)
8742 {
8743 if (strncmp (*str, arg, arg_len) == 0
8744 && ((*str)[arg_len] == '\0' || isspace ((*str)[arg_len])))
8745 {
8746 *str += arg_len;
8747 return 1;
8748 }
8749 return 0;
8750 }
8751
8752 /* A helper function that looks for the "-location" argument and then
8753 calls watch_command_1. */
8754
8755 static void
8756 watch_maybe_just_location (char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty)
8757 {
8758 int just_location = 0;
8759
8760 if (arg
8761 && (check_for_argument (&arg, "-location", sizeof ("-location") - 1)
8762 || check_for_argument (&arg, "-l", sizeof ("-l") - 1)))
8763 {
8764 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
8765 just_location = 1;
8766 }
8767
8768 watch_command_1 (arg, accessflag, from_tty, just_location, 0);
8769 }
8770
8771 static void
8772 watch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8773 {
8774 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_write, from_tty);
8775 }
8776
8777 void
8778 rwatch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
8779 {
8780 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_read, from_tty, 0, internal);
8781 }
8782
8783 static void
8784 rwatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8785 {
8786 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_read, from_tty);
8787 }
8788
8789 void
8790 awatch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
8791 {
8792 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_access, from_tty, 0, internal);
8793 }
8794
8795 static void
8796 awatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8797 {
8798 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_access, from_tty);
8799 }
8800 \f
8801
8802 /* Helper routines for the until_command routine in infcmd.c. Here
8803 because it uses the mechanisms of breakpoints. */
8804
8805 struct until_break_command_continuation_args
8806 {
8807 struct breakpoint *breakpoint;
8808 struct breakpoint *breakpoint2;
8809 int thread_num;
8810 };
8811
8812 /* This function is called by fetch_inferior_event via the
8813 cmd_continuation pointer, to complete the until command. It takes
8814 care of cleaning up the temporary breakpoints set up by the until
8815 command. */
8816 static void
8817 until_break_command_continuation (void *arg)
8818 {
8819 struct until_break_command_continuation_args *a = arg;
8820
8821 delete_breakpoint (a->breakpoint);
8822 if (a->breakpoint2)
8823 delete_breakpoint (a->breakpoint2);
8824 delete_longjmp_breakpoint (a->thread_num);
8825 }
8826
8827 void
8828 until_break_command (char *arg, int from_tty, int anywhere)
8829 {
8830 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
8831 struct symtab_and_line sal;
8832 struct frame_info *frame = get_selected_frame (NULL);
8833 struct breakpoint *breakpoint;
8834 struct breakpoint *breakpoint2 = NULL;
8835 struct cleanup *old_chain;
8836 int thread;
8837 struct thread_info *tp;
8838
8839 clear_proceed_status ();
8840
8841 /* Set a breakpoint where the user wants it and at return from
8842 this function. */
8843
8844 if (default_breakpoint_valid)
8845 sals = decode_line_1 (&arg, 1, default_breakpoint_symtab,
8846 default_breakpoint_line, (char ***) NULL, NULL);
8847 else
8848 sals = decode_line_1 (&arg, 1, (struct symtab *) NULL,
8849 0, (char ***) NULL, NULL);
8850
8851 if (sals.nelts != 1)
8852 error (_("Couldn't get information on specified line."));
8853
8854 sal = sals.sals[0];
8855 xfree (sals.sals); /* malloc'd, so freed. */
8856
8857 if (*arg)
8858 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
8859
8860 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
8861
8862 if (anywhere)
8863 /* If the user told us to continue until a specified location,
8864 we don't specify a frame at which we need to stop. */
8865 breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (get_frame_arch (frame), sal,
8866 null_frame_id, bp_until);
8867 else
8868 /* Otherwise, specify the selected frame, because we want to stop
8869 only at the very same frame. */
8870 breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (get_frame_arch (frame), sal,
8871 get_stack_frame_id (frame),
8872 bp_until);
8873
8874 old_chain = make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (breakpoint);
8875
8876 tp = inferior_thread ();
8877 thread = tp->num;
8878
8879 /* Keep within the current frame, or in frames called by the current
8880 one. */
8881
8882 if (frame_id_p (frame_unwind_caller_id (frame)))
8883 {
8884 sal = find_pc_line (frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame), 0);
8885 sal.pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
8886 breakpoint2 = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame),
8887 sal,
8888 frame_unwind_caller_id (frame),
8889 bp_until);
8890 make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (breakpoint2);
8891
8892 set_longjmp_breakpoint (tp, frame_unwind_caller_id (frame));
8893 make_cleanup (delete_longjmp_breakpoint_cleanup, &thread);
8894 }
8895
8896 proceed (-1, TARGET_SIGNAL_DEFAULT, 0);
8897
8898 /* If we are running asynchronously, and proceed call above has
8899 actually managed to start the target, arrange for breakpoints to
8900 be deleted when the target stops. Otherwise, we're already
8901 stopped and delete breakpoints via cleanup chain. */
8902
8903 if (target_can_async_p () && is_running (inferior_ptid))
8904 {
8905 struct until_break_command_continuation_args *args;
8906 args = xmalloc (sizeof (*args));
8907
8908 args->breakpoint = breakpoint;
8909 args->breakpoint2 = breakpoint2;
8910 args->thread_num = thread;
8911
8912 discard_cleanups (old_chain);
8913 add_continuation (inferior_thread (),
8914 until_break_command_continuation, args,
8915 xfree);
8916 }
8917 else
8918 do_cleanups (old_chain);
8919 }
8920
8921 /* This function attempts to parse an optional "if <cond>" clause
8922 from the arg string. If one is not found, it returns NULL.
8923
8924 Else, it returns a pointer to the condition string. (It does not
8925 attempt to evaluate the string against a particular block.) And,
8926 it updates arg to point to the first character following the parsed
8927 if clause in the arg string. */
8928
8929 static char *
8930 ep_parse_optional_if_clause (char **arg)
8931 {
8932 char *cond_string;
8933
8934 if (((*arg)[0] != 'i') || ((*arg)[1] != 'f') || !isspace ((*arg)[2]))
8935 return NULL;
8936
8937 /* Skip the "if" keyword. */
8938 (*arg) += 2;
8939
8940 /* Skip any extra leading whitespace, and record the start of the
8941 condition string. */
8942 *arg = skip_spaces (*arg);
8943 cond_string = *arg;
8944
8945 /* Assume that the condition occupies the remainder of the arg
8946 string. */
8947 (*arg) += strlen (cond_string);
8948
8949 return cond_string;
8950 }
8951
8952 /* Commands to deal with catching events, such as signals, exceptions,
8953 process start/exit, etc. */
8954
8955 typedef enum
8956 {
8957 catch_fork_temporary, catch_vfork_temporary,
8958 catch_fork_permanent, catch_vfork_permanent
8959 }
8960 catch_fork_kind;
8961
8962 static void
8963 catch_fork_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty,
8964 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8965 {
8966 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
8967 char *cond_string = NULL;
8968 catch_fork_kind fork_kind;
8969 int tempflag;
8970
8971 fork_kind = (catch_fork_kind) (uintptr_t) get_cmd_context (command);
8972 tempflag = (fork_kind == catch_fork_temporary
8973 || fork_kind == catch_vfork_temporary);
8974
8975 if (!arg)
8976 arg = "";
8977 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
8978
8979 /* The allowed syntax is:
8980 catch [v]fork
8981 catch [v]fork if <cond>
8982
8983 First, check if there's an if clause. */
8984 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
8985
8986 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
8987 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
8988
8989 /* If this target supports it, create a fork or vfork catchpoint
8990 and enable reporting of such events. */
8991 switch (fork_kind)
8992 {
8993 case catch_fork_temporary:
8994 case catch_fork_permanent:
8995 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
8996 &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops);
8997 break;
8998 case catch_vfork_temporary:
8999 case catch_vfork_permanent:
9000 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
9001 &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops);
9002 break;
9003 default:
9004 error (_("unsupported or unknown fork kind; cannot catch it"));
9005 break;
9006 }
9007 }
9008
9009 static void
9010 catch_exec_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty,
9011 struct cmd_list_element *command)
9012 {
9013 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
9014 int tempflag;
9015 char *cond_string = NULL;
9016
9017 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
9018
9019 if (!arg)
9020 arg = "";
9021 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
9022
9023 /* The allowed syntax is:
9024 catch exec
9025 catch exec if <cond>
9026
9027 First, check if there's an if clause. */
9028 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
9029
9030 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
9031 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
9032
9033 /* If this target supports it, create an exec catchpoint
9034 and enable reporting of such events. */
9035 create_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
9036 &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops);
9037 }
9038
9039 static enum print_stop_action
9040 print_exception_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
9041 {
9042 int bp_temp, bp_throw;
9043
9044 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
9045
9046 bp_throw = strstr (b->addr_string, "throw") != NULL;
9047 if (b->loc->address != b->loc->requested_address)
9048 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (b->loc->requested_address,
9049 b->loc->address,
9050 b->number, 1);
9051 bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
9052 ui_out_text (uiout,
9053 bp_temp ? "Temporary catchpoint "
9054 : "Catchpoint ");
9055 if (!ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
9056 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
9057 ui_out_text (uiout,
9058 bp_throw ? " (exception thrown), "
9059 : " (exception caught), ");
9060 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
9061 {
9062 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
9063 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
9064 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
9065 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
9066 }
9067 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
9068 }
9069
9070 static void
9071 print_one_exception_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
9072 struct bp_location **last_loc)
9073 {
9074 struct value_print_options opts;
9075
9076 get_user_print_options (&opts);
9077 if (opts.addressprint)
9078 {
9079 annotate_field (4);
9080 if (b->loc == NULL || b->loc->shlib_disabled)
9081 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<PENDING>");
9082 else
9083 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "addr",
9084 b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address);
9085 }
9086 annotate_field (5);
9087 if (b->loc)
9088 *last_loc = b->loc;
9089 if (strstr (b->addr_string, "throw") != NULL)
9090 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "exception throw");
9091 else
9092 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "exception catch");
9093 }
9094
9095 static void
9096 print_mention_exception_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
9097 {
9098 int bp_temp;
9099 int bp_throw;
9100
9101 bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
9102 bp_throw = strstr (b->addr_string, "throw") != NULL;
9103 ui_out_text (uiout, bp_temp ? _("Temporary catchpoint ")
9104 : _("Catchpoint "));
9105 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
9106 ui_out_text (uiout, bp_throw ? _(" (throw)")
9107 : _(" (catch)"));
9108 }
9109
9110 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for throw and
9111 catch catchpoints. */
9112
9113 static void
9114 print_recreate_exception_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
9115 struct ui_file *fp)
9116 {
9117 int bp_temp;
9118 int bp_throw;
9119
9120 bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
9121 bp_throw = strstr (b->addr_string, "throw") != NULL;
9122 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, bp_temp ? "tcatch " : "catch ");
9123 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, bp_throw ? "throw" : "catch");
9124 }
9125
9126 static struct breakpoint_ops gnu_v3_exception_catchpoint_ops = {
9127 NULL, /* insert */
9128 NULL, /* remove */
9129 NULL, /* breakpoint_hit */
9130 NULL, /* resources_needed */
9131 print_exception_catchpoint,
9132 print_one_exception_catchpoint,
9133 print_mention_exception_catchpoint,
9134 print_recreate_exception_catchpoint
9135 };
9136
9137 static int
9138 handle_gnu_v3_exceptions (int tempflag, char *cond_string,
9139 enum exception_event_kind ex_event, int from_tty)
9140 {
9141 char *trigger_func_name;
9142
9143 if (ex_event == EX_EVENT_CATCH)
9144 trigger_func_name = "__cxa_begin_catch";
9145 else
9146 trigger_func_name = "__cxa_throw";
9147
9148 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
9149 trigger_func_name, cond_string, -1,
9150 0 /* condition and thread are valid. */,
9151 tempflag, bp_breakpoint,
9152 0,
9153 AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE /* pending */,
9154 &gnu_v3_exception_catchpoint_ops, from_tty,
9155 1 /* enabled */,
9156 0 /* internal */);
9157
9158 return 1;
9159 }
9160
9161 /* Deal with "catch catch" and "catch throw" commands. */
9162
9163 static void
9164 catch_exception_command_1 (enum exception_event_kind ex_event, char *arg,
9165 int tempflag, int from_tty)
9166 {
9167 char *cond_string = NULL;
9168
9169 if (!arg)
9170 arg = "";
9171 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
9172
9173 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
9174
9175 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
9176 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
9177
9178 if (ex_event != EX_EVENT_THROW
9179 && ex_event != EX_EVENT_CATCH)
9180 error (_("Unsupported or unknown exception event; cannot catch it"));
9181
9182 if (handle_gnu_v3_exceptions (tempflag, cond_string, ex_event, from_tty))
9183 return;
9184
9185 warning (_("Unsupported with this platform/compiler combination."));
9186 }
9187
9188 /* Implementation of "catch catch" command. */
9189
9190 static void
9191 catch_catch_command (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
9192 {
9193 int tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
9194
9195 catch_exception_command_1 (EX_EVENT_CATCH, arg, tempflag, from_tty);
9196 }
9197
9198 /* Implementation of "catch throw" command. */
9199
9200 static void
9201 catch_throw_command (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
9202 {
9203 int tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
9204
9205 catch_exception_command_1 (EX_EVENT_THROW, arg, tempflag, from_tty);
9206 }
9207
9208 /* Create a breakpoint struct for Ada exception catchpoints. */
9209
9210 static void
9211 create_ada_exception_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9212 struct symtab_and_line sal,
9213 char *addr_string,
9214 char *exp_string,
9215 char *cond_string,
9216 struct expression *cond,
9217 struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
9218 int tempflag,
9219 int from_tty)
9220 {
9221 struct breakpoint *b;
9222
9223 if (from_tty)
9224 {
9225 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
9226 if (!loc_gdbarch)
9227 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
9228
9229 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
9230 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, -1);
9231 /* FIXME: brobecker/2006-12-28: Actually, re-implement a special
9232 version for exception catchpoints, because two catchpoints
9233 used for different exception names will use the same address.
9234 In this case, a "breakpoint ... also set at..." warning is
9235 unproductive. Besides, the warning phrasing is also a bit
9236 inapropriate, we should use the word catchpoint, and tell
9237 the user what type of catchpoint it is. The above is good
9238 enough for now, though. */
9239 }
9240
9241 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, bp_breakpoint);
9242 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
9243
9244 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
9245 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
9246 b->number = breakpoint_count;
9247 b->ignore_count = 0;
9248 b->loc->cond = cond;
9249 b->addr_string = addr_string;
9250 b->language = language_ada;
9251 b->cond_string = cond_string;
9252 b->exp_string = exp_string;
9253 b->thread = -1;
9254 b->ops = ops;
9255
9256 mention (b);
9257 update_global_location_list (1);
9258 }
9259
9260 /* Implement the "catch exception" command. */
9261
9262 static void
9263 catch_ada_exception_command (char *arg, int from_tty,
9264 struct cmd_list_element *command)
9265 {
9266 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
9267 int tempflag;
9268 struct symtab_and_line sal;
9269 char *addr_string = NULL;
9270 char *exp_string = NULL;
9271 char *cond_string = NULL;
9272 struct expression *cond = NULL;
9273 struct breakpoint_ops *ops = NULL;
9274
9275 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
9276
9277 if (!arg)
9278 arg = "";
9279 sal = ada_decode_exception_location (arg, &addr_string, &exp_string,
9280 &cond_string, &cond, &ops);
9281 create_ada_exception_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, addr_string, exp_string,
9282 cond_string, cond, ops, tempflag,
9283 from_tty);
9284 }
9285
9286 /* Cleanup function for a syscall filter list. */
9287 static void
9288 clean_up_filters (void *arg)
9289 {
9290 VEC(int) *iter = *(VEC(int) **) arg;
9291 VEC_free (int, iter);
9292 }
9293
9294 /* Splits the argument using space as delimiter. Returns an xmalloc'd
9295 filter list, or NULL if no filtering is required. */
9296 static VEC(int) *
9297 catch_syscall_split_args (char *arg)
9298 {
9299 VEC(int) *result = NULL;
9300 struct cleanup *cleanup = make_cleanup (clean_up_filters, &result);
9301
9302 while (*arg != '\0')
9303 {
9304 int i, syscall_number;
9305 char *endptr;
9306 char cur_name[128];
9307 struct syscall s;
9308
9309 /* Skip whitespace. */
9310 while (isspace (*arg))
9311 arg++;
9312
9313 for (i = 0; i < 127 && arg[i] && !isspace (arg[i]); ++i)
9314 cur_name[i] = arg[i];
9315 cur_name[i] = '\0';
9316 arg += i;
9317
9318 /* Check if the user provided a syscall name or a number. */
9319 syscall_number = (int) strtol (cur_name, &endptr, 0);
9320 if (*endptr == '\0')
9321 get_syscall_by_number (syscall_number, &s);
9322 else
9323 {
9324 /* We have a name. Let's check if it's valid and convert it
9325 to a number. */
9326 get_syscall_by_name (cur_name, &s);
9327
9328 if (s.number == UNKNOWN_SYSCALL)
9329 /* Here we have to issue an error instead of a warning,
9330 because GDB cannot do anything useful if there's no
9331 syscall number to be caught. */
9332 error (_("Unknown syscall name '%s'."), cur_name);
9333 }
9334
9335 /* Ok, it's valid. */
9336 VEC_safe_push (int, result, s.number);
9337 }
9338
9339 discard_cleanups (cleanup);
9340 return result;
9341 }
9342
9343 /* Implement the "catch syscall" command. */
9344
9345 static void
9346 catch_syscall_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty,
9347 struct cmd_list_element *command)
9348 {
9349 int tempflag;
9350 VEC(int) *filter;
9351 struct syscall s;
9352 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
9353
9354 /* Checking if the feature if supported. */
9355 if (gdbarch_get_syscall_number_p (gdbarch) == 0)
9356 error (_("The feature 'catch syscall' is not supported on \
9357 this architecture yet."));
9358
9359 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
9360
9361 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
9362
9363 /* We need to do this first "dummy" translation in order
9364 to get the syscall XML file loaded or, most important,
9365 to display a warning to the user if there's no XML file
9366 for his/her architecture. */
9367 get_syscall_by_number (0, &s);
9368
9369 /* The allowed syntax is:
9370 catch syscall
9371 catch syscall <name | number> [<name | number> ... <name | number>]
9372
9373 Let's check if there's a syscall name. */
9374
9375 if (arg != NULL)
9376 filter = catch_syscall_split_args (arg);
9377 else
9378 filter = NULL;
9379
9380 create_syscall_event_catchpoint (tempflag, filter,
9381 &catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops);
9382 }
9383
9384 /* Implement the "catch assert" command. */
9385
9386 static void
9387 catch_assert_command (char *arg, int from_tty,
9388 struct cmd_list_element *command)
9389 {
9390 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
9391 int tempflag;
9392 struct symtab_and_line sal;
9393 char *addr_string = NULL;
9394 struct breakpoint_ops *ops = NULL;
9395
9396 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
9397
9398 if (!arg)
9399 arg = "";
9400 sal = ada_decode_assert_location (arg, &addr_string, &ops);
9401 create_ada_exception_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, addr_string, NULL, NULL, NULL,
9402 ops, tempflag, from_tty);
9403 }
9404
9405 static void
9406 catch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9407 {
9408 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
9409 }
9410 \f
9411
9412 static void
9413 tcatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9414 {
9415 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
9416 }
9417
9418 /* Delete breakpoints by address or line. */
9419
9420 static void
9421 clear_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9422 {
9423 struct breakpoint *b;
9424 VEC(breakpoint_p) *found = 0;
9425 int ix;
9426 int default_match;
9427 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
9428 struct symtab_and_line sal;
9429 int i;
9430
9431 if (arg)
9432 {
9433 sals = decode_line_spec (arg, 1);
9434 default_match = 0;
9435 }
9436 else
9437 {
9438 sals.sals = (struct symtab_and_line *)
9439 xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
9440 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
9441 init_sal (&sal); /* Initialize to zeroes. */
9442 sal.line = default_breakpoint_line;
9443 sal.symtab = default_breakpoint_symtab;
9444 sal.pc = default_breakpoint_address;
9445 sal.pspace = default_breakpoint_pspace;
9446 if (sal.symtab == 0)
9447 error (_("No source file specified."));
9448
9449 sals.sals[0] = sal;
9450 sals.nelts = 1;
9451
9452 default_match = 1;
9453 }
9454
9455 /* We don't call resolve_sal_pc here. That's not as bad as it
9456 seems, because all existing breakpoints typically have both
9457 file/line and pc set. So, if clear is given file/line, we can
9458 match this to existing breakpoint without obtaining pc at all.
9459
9460 We only support clearing given the address explicitly
9461 present in breakpoint table. Say, we've set breakpoint
9462 at file:line. There were several PC values for that file:line,
9463 due to optimization, all in one block.
9464
9465 We've picked one PC value. If "clear" is issued with another
9466 PC corresponding to the same file:line, the breakpoint won't
9467 be cleared. We probably can still clear the breakpoint, but
9468 since the other PC value is never presented to user, user
9469 can only find it by guessing, and it does not seem important
9470 to support that. */
9471
9472 /* For each line spec given, delete bps which correspond to it. Do
9473 it in two passes, solely to preserve the current behavior that
9474 from_tty is forced true if we delete more than one
9475 breakpoint. */
9476
9477 found = NULL;
9478 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; i++)
9479 {
9480 /* If exact pc given, clear bpts at that pc.
9481 If line given (pc == 0), clear all bpts on specified line.
9482 If defaulting, clear all bpts on default line
9483 or at default pc.
9484
9485 defaulting sal.pc != 0 tests to do
9486
9487 0 1 pc
9488 1 1 pc _and_ line
9489 0 0 line
9490 1 0 <can't happen> */
9491
9492 sal = sals.sals[i];
9493
9494 /* Find all matching breakpoints and add them to 'found'. */
9495 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
9496 {
9497 int match = 0;
9498 /* Are we going to delete b? */
9499 if (b->type != bp_none && !is_watchpoint (b))
9500 {
9501 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
9502 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
9503 {
9504 int pc_match = sal.pc
9505 && (loc->pspace == sal.pspace)
9506 && (loc->address == sal.pc)
9507 && (!section_is_overlay (loc->section)
9508 || loc->section == sal.section);
9509 int line_match = ((default_match || (0 == sal.pc))
9510 && b->source_file != NULL
9511 && sal.symtab != NULL
9512 && sal.pspace == loc->pspace
9513 && strcmp (b->source_file,
9514 sal.symtab->filename) == 0
9515 && b->line_number == sal.line);
9516 if (pc_match || line_match)
9517 {
9518 match = 1;
9519 break;
9520 }
9521 }
9522 }
9523
9524 if (match)
9525 VEC_safe_push(breakpoint_p, found, b);
9526 }
9527 }
9528 /* Now go thru the 'found' chain and delete them. */
9529 if (VEC_empty(breakpoint_p, found))
9530 {
9531 if (arg)
9532 error (_("No breakpoint at %s."), arg);
9533 else
9534 error (_("No breakpoint at this line."));
9535 }
9536
9537 if (VEC_length(breakpoint_p, found) > 1)
9538 from_tty = 1; /* Always report if deleted more than one. */
9539 if (from_tty)
9540 {
9541 if (VEC_length(breakpoint_p, found) == 1)
9542 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoint "));
9543 else
9544 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoints "));
9545 }
9546 breakpoints_changed ();
9547
9548 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate(breakpoint_p, found, ix, b); ix++)
9549 {
9550 if (from_tty)
9551 printf_unfiltered ("%d ", b->number);
9552 delete_breakpoint (b);
9553 }
9554 if (from_tty)
9555 putchar_unfiltered ('\n');
9556 }
9557 \f
9558 /* Delete breakpoint in BS if they are `delete' breakpoints and
9559 all breakpoints that are marked for deletion, whether hit or not.
9560 This is called after any breakpoint is hit, or after errors. */
9561
9562 void
9563 breakpoint_auto_delete (bpstat bs)
9564 {
9565 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
9566
9567 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
9568 if (bs->breakpoint_at
9569 && bs->breakpoint_at->disposition == disp_del
9570 && bs->stop)
9571 delete_breakpoint (bs->breakpoint_at);
9572
9573 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
9574 {
9575 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
9576 delete_breakpoint (b);
9577 }
9578 }
9579
9580 /* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP being interfaced to
9581 qsort. Sort elements primarily by their ADDRESS (no matter what
9582 does breakpoint_address_is_meaningful say for its OWNER),
9583 secondarily by ordering first bp_permanent OWNERed elements and
9584 terciarily just ensuring the array is sorted stable way despite
9585 qsort being an instable algorithm. */
9586
9587 static int
9588 bp_location_compare (const void *ap, const void *bp)
9589 {
9590 struct bp_location *a = *(void **) ap;
9591 struct bp_location *b = *(void **) bp;
9592 /* A and B come from existing breakpoints having non-NULL OWNER. */
9593 int a_perm = a->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent;
9594 int b_perm = b->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent;
9595
9596 if (a->address != b->address)
9597 return (a->address > b->address) - (a->address < b->address);
9598
9599 /* Sort permanent breakpoints first. */
9600 if (a_perm != b_perm)
9601 return (a_perm < b_perm) - (a_perm > b_perm);
9602
9603 /* Make the user-visible order stable across GDB runs. Locations of
9604 the same breakpoint can be sorted in arbitrary order. */
9605
9606 if (a->owner->number != b->owner->number)
9607 return (a->owner->number > b->owner->number)
9608 - (a->owner->number < b->owner->number);
9609
9610 return (a > b) - (a < b);
9611 }
9612
9613 /* Set bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max and
9614 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max according to the current
9615 content of the bp_location array. */
9616
9617 static void
9618 bp_location_target_extensions_update (void)
9619 {
9620 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
9621
9622 bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max = 0;
9623 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max = 0;
9624
9625 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
9626 {
9627 CORE_ADDR start, end, addr;
9628
9629 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
9630 continue;
9631
9632 start = bl->target_info.placed_address;
9633 end = start + bl->target_info.shadow_len;
9634
9635 gdb_assert (bl->address >= start);
9636 addr = bl->address - start;
9637 if (addr > bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max)
9638 bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max = addr;
9639
9640 /* Zero SHADOW_LEN would not pass bp_location_has_shadow. */
9641
9642 gdb_assert (bl->address < end);
9643 addr = end - bl->address;
9644 if (addr > bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max)
9645 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max = addr;
9646 }
9647 }
9648
9649 /* If SHOULD_INSERT is false, do not insert any breakpoint locations
9650 into the inferior, only remove already-inserted locations that no
9651 longer should be inserted. Functions that delete a breakpoint or
9652 breakpoints should pass false, so that deleting a breakpoint
9653 doesn't have the side effect of inserting the locations of other
9654 breakpoints that are marked not-inserted, but should_be_inserted
9655 returns true on them.
9656
9657 This behaviour is useful is situations close to tear-down -- e.g.,
9658 after an exec, while the target still has execution, but breakpoint
9659 shadows of the previous executable image should *NOT* be restored
9660 to the new image; or before detaching, where the target still has
9661 execution and wants to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists, and all
9662 breakpoints had already been removed from the inferior. */
9663
9664 static void
9665 update_global_location_list (int should_insert)
9666 {
9667 struct breakpoint *b;
9668 struct bp_location **locp, *loc;
9669 struct cleanup *cleanups;
9670
9671 /* Used in the duplicates detection below. When iterating over all
9672 bp_locations, points to the first bp_location of a given address.
9673 Breakpoints and watchpoints of different types are never
9674 duplicates of each other. Keep one pointer for each type of
9675 breakpoint/watchpoint, so we only need to loop over all locations
9676 once. */
9677 struct bp_location *bp_loc_first; /* breakpoint */
9678 struct bp_location *wp_loc_first; /* hardware watchpoint */
9679 struct bp_location *awp_loc_first; /* access watchpoint */
9680 struct bp_location *rwp_loc_first; /* read watchpoint */
9681
9682 /* Saved former bp_location array which we compare against the newly
9683 built bp_location from the current state of ALL_BREAKPOINTS. */
9684 struct bp_location **old_location, **old_locp;
9685 unsigned old_location_count;
9686
9687 old_location = bp_location;
9688 old_location_count = bp_location_count;
9689 bp_location = NULL;
9690 bp_location_count = 0;
9691 cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, old_location);
9692
9693 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
9694 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
9695 bp_location_count++;
9696
9697 bp_location = xmalloc (sizeof (*bp_location) * bp_location_count);
9698 locp = bp_location;
9699 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
9700 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
9701 *locp++ = loc;
9702 qsort (bp_location, bp_location_count, sizeof (*bp_location),
9703 bp_location_compare);
9704
9705 bp_location_target_extensions_update ();
9706
9707 /* Identify bp_location instances that are no longer present in the
9708 new list, and therefore should be freed. Note that it's not
9709 necessary that those locations should be removed from inferior --
9710 if there's another location at the same address (previously
9711 marked as duplicate), we don't need to remove/insert the
9712 location.
9713
9714 LOCP is kept in sync with OLD_LOCP, each pointing to the current
9715 and former bp_location array state respectively. */
9716
9717 locp = bp_location;
9718 for (old_locp = old_location; old_locp < old_location + old_location_count;
9719 old_locp++)
9720 {
9721 struct bp_location *old_loc = *old_locp;
9722 struct bp_location **loc2p;
9723
9724 /* Tells if 'old_loc' is found amoung the new locations. If
9725 not, we have to free it. */
9726 int found_object = 0;
9727 /* Tells if the location should remain inserted in the target. */
9728 int keep_in_target = 0;
9729 int removed = 0;
9730
9731 /* Skip LOCP entries which will definitely never be needed.
9732 Stop either at or being the one matching OLD_LOC. */
9733 while (locp < bp_location + bp_location_count
9734 && (*locp)->address < old_loc->address)
9735 locp++;
9736
9737 for (loc2p = locp;
9738 (loc2p < bp_location + bp_location_count
9739 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
9740 loc2p++)
9741 {
9742 if (*loc2p == old_loc)
9743 {
9744 found_object = 1;
9745 break;
9746 }
9747 }
9748
9749 /* If this location is no longer present, and inserted, look if
9750 there's maybe a new location at the same address. If so,
9751 mark that one inserted, and don't remove this one. This is
9752 needed so that we don't have a time window where a breakpoint
9753 at certain location is not inserted. */
9754
9755 if (old_loc->inserted)
9756 {
9757 /* If the location is inserted now, we might have to remove
9758 it. */
9759
9760 if (found_object && should_be_inserted (old_loc))
9761 {
9762 /* The location is still present in the location list,
9763 and still should be inserted. Don't do anything. */
9764 keep_in_target = 1;
9765 }
9766 else
9767 {
9768 /* The location is either no longer present, or got
9769 disabled. See if there's another location at the
9770 same address, in which case we don't need to remove
9771 this one from the target. */
9772
9773 /* OLD_LOC comes from existing struct breakpoint. */
9774 if (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (old_loc->owner))
9775 {
9776 for (loc2p = locp;
9777 (loc2p < bp_location + bp_location_count
9778 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
9779 loc2p++)
9780 {
9781 struct bp_location *loc2 = *loc2p;
9782
9783 if (breakpoint_locations_match (loc2, old_loc))
9784 {
9785 /* For the sake of should_be_inserted.
9786 Duplicates check below will fix up this
9787 later. */
9788 loc2->duplicate = 0;
9789
9790 /* Read watchpoint locations are switched to
9791 access watchpoints, if the former are not
9792 supported, but the latter are. */
9793 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (old_loc->owner))
9794 {
9795 gdb_assert (is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner));
9796 loc2->watchpoint_type = old_loc->watchpoint_type;
9797 }
9798
9799 if (loc2 != old_loc && should_be_inserted (loc2))
9800 {
9801 loc2->inserted = 1;
9802 loc2->target_info = old_loc->target_info;
9803 keep_in_target = 1;
9804 break;
9805 }
9806 }
9807 }
9808 }
9809 }
9810
9811 if (!keep_in_target)
9812 {
9813 if (remove_breakpoint (old_loc, mark_uninserted))
9814 {
9815 /* This is just about all we can do. We could keep
9816 this location on the global list, and try to
9817 remove it next time, but there's no particular
9818 reason why we will succeed next time.
9819
9820 Note that at this point, old_loc->owner is still
9821 valid, as delete_breakpoint frees the breakpoint
9822 only after calling us. */
9823 printf_filtered (_("warning: Error removing "
9824 "breakpoint %d\n"),
9825 old_loc->owner->number);
9826 }
9827 removed = 1;
9828 }
9829 }
9830
9831 if (!found_object)
9832 {
9833 if (removed && non_stop
9834 && breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (old_loc->owner)
9835 && !is_hardware_watchpoint (old_loc->owner))
9836 {
9837 /* This location was removed from the target. In
9838 non-stop mode, a race condition is possible where
9839 we've removed a breakpoint, but stop events for that
9840 breakpoint are already queued and will arrive later.
9841 We apply an heuristic to be able to distinguish such
9842 SIGTRAPs from other random SIGTRAPs: we keep this
9843 breakpoint location for a bit, and will retire it
9844 after we see some number of events. The theory here
9845 is that reporting of events should, "on the average",
9846 be fair, so after a while we'll see events from all
9847 threads that have anything of interest, and no longer
9848 need to keep this breakpoint location around. We
9849 don't hold locations forever so to reduce chances of
9850 mistaking a non-breakpoint SIGTRAP for a breakpoint
9851 SIGTRAP.
9852
9853 The heuristic failing can be disastrous on
9854 decr_pc_after_break targets.
9855
9856 On decr_pc_after_break targets, like e.g., x86-linux,
9857 if we fail to recognize a late breakpoint SIGTRAP,
9858 because events_till_retirement has reached 0 too
9859 soon, we'll fail to do the PC adjustment, and report
9860 a random SIGTRAP to the user. When the user resumes
9861 the inferior, it will most likely immediately crash
9862 with SIGILL/SIGBUS/SIGSEGV, or worse, get silently
9863 corrupted, because of being resumed e.g., in the
9864 middle of a multi-byte instruction, or skipped a
9865 one-byte instruction. This was actually seen happen
9866 on native x86-linux, and should be less rare on
9867 targets that do not support new thread events, like
9868 remote, due to the heuristic depending on
9869 thread_count.
9870
9871 Mistaking a random SIGTRAP for a breakpoint trap
9872 causes similar symptoms (PC adjustment applied when
9873 it shouldn't), but then again, playing with SIGTRAPs
9874 behind the debugger's back is asking for trouble.
9875
9876 Since hardware watchpoint traps are always
9877 distinguishable from other traps, so we don't need to
9878 apply keep hardware watchpoint moribund locations
9879 around. We simply always ignore hardware watchpoint
9880 traps we can no longer explain. */
9881
9882 old_loc->events_till_retirement = 3 * (thread_count () + 1);
9883 old_loc->owner = NULL;
9884
9885 VEC_safe_push (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, old_loc);
9886 }
9887 else
9888 {
9889 old_loc->owner = NULL;
9890 decref_bp_location (&old_loc);
9891 }
9892 }
9893 }
9894
9895 /* Rescan breakpoints at the same address and section, marking the
9896 first one as "first" and any others as "duplicates". This is so
9897 that the bpt instruction is only inserted once. If we have a
9898 permanent breakpoint at the same place as BPT, make that one the
9899 official one, and the rest as duplicates. Permanent breakpoints
9900 are sorted first for the same address.
9901
9902 Do the same for hardware watchpoints, but also considering the
9903 watchpoint's type (regular/access/read) and length. */
9904
9905 bp_loc_first = NULL;
9906 wp_loc_first = NULL;
9907 awp_loc_first = NULL;
9908 rwp_loc_first = NULL;
9909 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp)
9910 {
9911 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always
9912 non-NULL. */
9913 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
9914 struct bp_location **loc_first_p;
9915
9916 if (b->enable_state == bp_disabled
9917 || b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled
9918 || b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled
9919 || !loc->enabled
9920 || loc->shlib_disabled
9921 || !breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (b)
9922 || is_tracepoint (b))
9923 continue;
9924
9925 /* Permanent breakpoint should always be inserted. */
9926 if (b->enable_state == bp_permanent && ! loc->inserted)
9927 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
9928 _("allegedly permanent breakpoint is not "
9929 "actually inserted"));
9930
9931 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
9932 loc_first_p = &wp_loc_first;
9933 else if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
9934 loc_first_p = &rwp_loc_first;
9935 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
9936 loc_first_p = &awp_loc_first;
9937 else
9938 loc_first_p = &bp_loc_first;
9939
9940 if (*loc_first_p == NULL
9941 || (overlay_debugging && loc->section != (*loc_first_p)->section)
9942 || !breakpoint_locations_match (loc, *loc_first_p))
9943 {
9944 *loc_first_p = loc;
9945 loc->duplicate = 0;
9946 continue;
9947 }
9948
9949 loc->duplicate = 1;
9950
9951 if ((*loc_first_p)->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent && loc->inserted
9952 && b->enable_state != bp_permanent)
9953 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
9954 _("another breakpoint was inserted on top of "
9955 "a permanent breakpoint"));
9956 }
9957
9958 if (breakpoints_always_inserted_mode () && should_insert
9959 && (have_live_inferiors ()
9960 || (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch))))
9961 insert_breakpoint_locations ();
9962
9963 do_cleanups (cleanups);
9964 }
9965
9966 void
9967 breakpoint_retire_moribund (void)
9968 {
9969 struct bp_location *loc;
9970 int ix;
9971
9972 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
9973 if (--(loc->events_till_retirement) == 0)
9974 {
9975 decref_bp_location (&loc);
9976 VEC_unordered_remove (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix);
9977 --ix;
9978 }
9979 }
9980
9981 static void
9982 update_global_location_list_nothrow (int inserting)
9983 {
9984 struct gdb_exception e;
9985
9986 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
9987 update_global_location_list (inserting);
9988 }
9989
9990 /* Clear BKP from a BPS. */
9991
9992 static void
9993 bpstat_remove_bp_location (bpstat bps, struct breakpoint *bpt)
9994 {
9995 bpstat bs;
9996
9997 for (bs = bps; bs; bs = bs->next)
9998 if (bs->breakpoint_at == bpt)
9999 {
10000 bs->breakpoint_at = NULL;
10001 bs->old_val = NULL;
10002 /* bs->commands will be freed later. */
10003 }
10004 }
10005
10006 /* Callback for iterate_over_threads. */
10007 static int
10008 bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback (struct thread_info *th, void *data)
10009 {
10010 struct breakpoint *bpt = data;
10011
10012 bpstat_remove_bp_location (th->control.stop_bpstat, bpt);
10013 return 0;
10014 }
10015
10016 /* Delete a breakpoint and clean up all traces of it in the data
10017 structures. */
10018
10019 void
10020 delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
10021 {
10022 struct breakpoint *b;
10023
10024 gdb_assert (bpt != NULL);
10025
10026 /* Has this bp already been deleted? This can happen because
10027 multiple lists can hold pointers to bp's. bpstat lists are
10028 especial culprits.
10029
10030 One example of this happening is a watchpoint's scope bp. When
10031 the scope bp triggers, we notice that the watchpoint is out of
10032 scope, and delete it. We also delete its scope bp. But the
10033 scope bp is marked "auto-deleting", and is already on a bpstat.
10034 That bpstat is then checked for auto-deleting bp's, which are
10035 deleted.
10036
10037 A real solution to this problem might involve reference counts in
10038 bp's, and/or giving them pointers back to their referencing
10039 bpstat's, and teaching delete_breakpoint to only free a bp's
10040 storage when no more references were extent. A cheaper bandaid
10041 was chosen. */
10042 if (bpt->type == bp_none)
10043 return;
10044
10045 /* At least avoid this stale reference until the reference counting
10046 of breakpoints gets resolved. */
10047 if (bpt->related_breakpoint != NULL)
10048 {
10049 gdb_assert (bpt->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint == bpt);
10050 bpt->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
10051 bpt->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = NULL;
10052 bpt->related_breakpoint = NULL;
10053 }
10054
10055 observer_notify_breakpoint_deleted (bpt->number);
10056
10057 if (breakpoint_chain == bpt)
10058 breakpoint_chain = bpt->next;
10059
10060 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
10061 if (b->next == bpt)
10062 {
10063 b->next = bpt->next;
10064 break;
10065 }
10066
10067 decref_counted_command_line (&bpt->commands);
10068 xfree (bpt->cond_string);
10069 xfree (bpt->cond_exp);
10070 xfree (bpt->addr_string);
10071 xfree (bpt->exp);
10072 xfree (bpt->exp_string);
10073 xfree (bpt->exp_string_reparse);
10074 value_free (bpt->val);
10075 xfree (bpt->source_file);
10076 xfree (bpt->exec_pathname);
10077 clean_up_filters (&bpt->syscalls_to_be_caught);
10078
10079
10080 /* Be sure no bpstat's are pointing at the breakpoint after it's
10081 been freed. */
10082 /* FIXME, how can we find all bpstat's? We just check stop_bpstat
10083 in all threeds for now. Note that we cannot just remove bpstats
10084 pointing at bpt from the stop_bpstat list entirely, as breakpoint
10085 commands are associated with the bpstat; if we remove it here,
10086 then the later call to bpstat_do_actions (&stop_bpstat); in
10087 event-top.c won't do anything, and temporary breakpoints with
10088 commands won't work. */
10089
10090 iterate_over_threads (bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback, bpt);
10091
10092 /* Now that breakpoint is removed from breakpoint list, update the
10093 global location list. This will remove locations that used to
10094 belong to this breakpoint. Do this before freeing the breakpoint
10095 itself, since remove_breakpoint looks at location's owner. It
10096 might be better design to have location completely
10097 self-contained, but it's not the case now. */
10098 update_global_location_list (0);
10099
10100
10101 /* On the chance that someone will soon try again to delete this
10102 same bp, we mark it as deleted before freeing its storage. */
10103 bpt->type = bp_none;
10104
10105 xfree (bpt);
10106 }
10107
10108 static void
10109 do_delete_breakpoint_cleanup (void *b)
10110 {
10111 delete_breakpoint (b);
10112 }
10113
10114 struct cleanup *
10115 make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10116 {
10117 return make_cleanup (do_delete_breakpoint_cleanup, b);
10118 }
10119
10120 /* A callback for map_breakpoint_numbers that calls
10121 delete_breakpoint. */
10122
10123 static void
10124 do_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, void *ignore)
10125 {
10126 delete_breakpoint (b);
10127 }
10128
10129 void
10130 delete_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10131 {
10132 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
10133
10134 dont_repeat ();
10135
10136 if (arg == 0)
10137 {
10138 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
10139
10140 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument.
10141 Do not delete internal or call-dummy breakpoints, these have
10142 to be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number argument. */
10143 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
10144 {
10145 if (b->type != bp_call_dummy
10146 && b->type != bp_std_terminate
10147 && b->type != bp_shlib_event
10148 && b->type != bp_jit_event
10149 && b->type != bp_thread_event
10150 && b->type != bp_overlay_event
10151 && b->type != bp_longjmp_master
10152 && b->type != bp_std_terminate_master
10153 && b->type != bp_exception_master
10154 && b->number >= 0)
10155 {
10156 breaks_to_delete = 1;
10157 break;
10158 }
10159 }
10160
10161 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
10162 if (!from_tty
10163 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all breakpoints? "))))
10164 {
10165 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
10166 {
10167 if (b->type != bp_call_dummy
10168 && b->type != bp_std_terminate
10169 && b->type != bp_shlib_event
10170 && b->type != bp_thread_event
10171 && b->type != bp_jit_event
10172 && b->type != bp_overlay_event
10173 && b->type != bp_longjmp_master
10174 && b->type != bp_std_terminate_master
10175 && b->type != bp_exception_master
10176 && b->number >= 0)
10177 delete_breakpoint (b);
10178 }
10179 }
10180 }
10181 else
10182 map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, do_delete_breakpoint, NULL);
10183 }
10184
10185 static int
10186 all_locations_are_pending (struct bp_location *loc)
10187 {
10188 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
10189 if (!loc->shlib_disabled)
10190 return 0;
10191 return 1;
10192 }
10193
10194 /* Subroutine of update_breakpoint_locations to simplify it.
10195 Return non-zero if multiple fns in list LOC have the same name.
10196 Null names are ignored. */
10197
10198 static int
10199 ambiguous_names_p (struct bp_location *loc)
10200 {
10201 struct bp_location *l;
10202 htab_t htab = htab_create_alloc (13, htab_hash_string,
10203 (int (*) (const void *,
10204 const void *)) streq,
10205 NULL, xcalloc, xfree);
10206
10207 for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->next)
10208 {
10209 const char **slot;
10210 const char *name = l->function_name;
10211
10212 /* Allow for some names to be NULL, ignore them. */
10213 if (name == NULL)
10214 continue;
10215
10216 slot = (const char **) htab_find_slot (htab, (const void *) name,
10217 INSERT);
10218 /* NOTE: We can assume slot != NULL here because xcalloc never
10219 returns NULL. */
10220 if (*slot != NULL)
10221 {
10222 htab_delete (htab);
10223 return 1;
10224 }
10225 *slot = name;
10226 }
10227
10228 htab_delete (htab);
10229 return 0;
10230 }
10231
10232 /* When symbols change, it probably means the sources changed as well,
10233 and it might mean the static tracepoint markers are no longer at
10234 the same address or line numbers they used to be at last we
10235 checked. Losing your static tracepoints whenever you rebuild is
10236 undesirable. This function tries to resync/rematch gdb static
10237 tracepoints with the markers on the target, for static tracepoints
10238 that have not been set by marker id. Static tracepoint that have
10239 been set by marker id are reset by marker id in breakpoint_re_set.
10240 The heuristic is:
10241
10242 1) For a tracepoint set at a specific address, look for a marker at
10243 the old PC. If one is found there, assume to be the same marker.
10244 If the name / string id of the marker found is different from the
10245 previous known name, assume that means the user renamed the marker
10246 in the sources, and output a warning.
10247
10248 2) For a tracepoint set at a given line number, look for a marker
10249 at the new address of the old line number. If one is found there,
10250 assume to be the same marker. If the name / string id of the
10251 marker found is different from the previous known name, assume that
10252 means the user renamed the marker in the sources, and output a
10253 warning.
10254
10255 3) If a marker is no longer found at the same address or line, it
10256 may mean the marker no longer exists. But it may also just mean
10257 the code changed a bit. Maybe the user added a few lines of code
10258 that made the marker move up or down (in line number terms). Ask
10259 the target for info about the marker with the string id as we knew
10260 it. If found, update line number and address in the matching
10261 static tracepoint. This will get confused if there's more than one
10262 marker with the same ID (possible in UST, although unadvised
10263 precisely because it confuses tools). */
10264
10265 static struct symtab_and_line
10266 update_static_tracepoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct symtab_and_line sal)
10267 {
10268 struct static_tracepoint_marker marker;
10269 CORE_ADDR pc;
10270 int i;
10271
10272 pc = sal.pc;
10273 if (sal.line)
10274 find_line_pc (sal.symtab, sal.line, &pc);
10275
10276 if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (pc, &marker))
10277 {
10278 if (strcmp (b->static_trace_marker_id, marker.str_id) != 0)
10279 warning (_("static tracepoint %d changed probed marker from %s to %s"),
10280 b->number,
10281 b->static_trace_marker_id, marker.str_id);
10282
10283 xfree (b->static_trace_marker_id);
10284 b->static_trace_marker_id = xstrdup (marker.str_id);
10285 release_static_tracepoint_marker (&marker);
10286
10287 return sal;
10288 }
10289
10290 /* Old marker wasn't found on target at lineno. Try looking it up
10291 by string ID. */
10292 if (!sal.explicit_pc
10293 && sal.line != 0
10294 && sal.symtab != NULL
10295 && b->static_trace_marker_id != NULL)
10296 {
10297 VEC(static_tracepoint_marker_p) *markers;
10298
10299 markers
10300 = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid (b->static_trace_marker_id);
10301
10302 if (!VEC_empty(static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers))
10303 {
10304 struct symtab_and_line sal;
10305 struct symbol *sym;
10306 struct static_tracepoint_marker *marker;
10307
10308 marker = VEC_index (static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers, 0);
10309
10310 xfree (b->static_trace_marker_id);
10311 b->static_trace_marker_id = xstrdup (marker->str_id);
10312
10313 warning (_("marker for static tracepoint %d (%s) not "
10314 "found at previous line number"),
10315 b->number, b->static_trace_marker_id);
10316
10317 init_sal (&sal);
10318
10319 sal.pc = marker->address;
10320
10321 sal = find_pc_line (marker->address, 0);
10322 sym = find_pc_sect_function (marker->address, NULL);
10323 ui_out_text (uiout, "Now in ");
10324 if (sym)
10325 {
10326 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "func",
10327 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym));
10328 ui_out_text (uiout, " at ");
10329 }
10330 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "file", sal.symtab->filename);
10331 ui_out_text (uiout, ":");
10332
10333 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10334 {
10335 char *fullname = symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab);
10336
10337 if (fullname)
10338 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "fullname", fullname);
10339 }
10340
10341 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "line", sal.line);
10342 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
10343
10344 b->line_number = sal.line;
10345
10346 xfree (b->source_file);
10347 if (sym)
10348 b->source_file = xstrdup (sal.symtab->filename);
10349 else
10350 b->source_file = NULL;
10351
10352 xfree (b->addr_string);
10353 b->addr_string = xstrprintf ("%s:%d",
10354 sal.symtab->filename, b->line_number);
10355
10356 /* Might be nice to check if function changed, and warn if
10357 so. */
10358
10359 release_static_tracepoint_marker (marker);
10360 }
10361 }
10362 return sal;
10363 }
10364
10365 static void
10366 update_breakpoint_locations (struct breakpoint *b,
10367 struct symtabs_and_lines sals)
10368 {
10369 int i;
10370 char *s;
10371 struct bp_location *existing_locations = b->loc;
10372
10373 /* If there's no new locations, and all existing locations are
10374 pending, don't do anything. This optimizes the common case where
10375 all locations are in the same shared library, that was unloaded.
10376 We'd like to retain the location, so that when the library is
10377 loaded again, we don't loose the enabled/disabled status of the
10378 individual locations. */
10379 if (all_locations_are_pending (existing_locations) && sals.nelts == 0)
10380 return;
10381
10382 b->loc = NULL;
10383
10384 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
10385 {
10386 struct bp_location *new_loc =
10387 add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &(sals.sals[i]));
10388
10389 /* Reparse conditions, they might contain references to the
10390 old symtab. */
10391 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
10392 {
10393 struct gdb_exception e;
10394
10395 s = b->cond_string;
10396 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
10397 {
10398 new_loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&s, block_for_pc (sals.sals[i].pc),
10399 0);
10400 }
10401 if (e.reason < 0)
10402 {
10403 warning (_("failed to reevaluate condition "
10404 "for breakpoint %d: %s"),
10405 b->number, e.message);
10406 new_loc->enabled = 0;
10407 }
10408 }
10409
10410 if (b->source_file != NULL)
10411 xfree (b->source_file);
10412 if (sals.sals[i].symtab == NULL)
10413 b->source_file = NULL;
10414 else
10415 b->source_file = xstrdup (sals.sals[i].symtab->filename);
10416
10417 if (b->line_number == 0)
10418 b->line_number = sals.sals[i].line;
10419 }
10420
10421 /* Update locations of permanent breakpoints. */
10422 if (b->enable_state == bp_permanent)
10423 make_breakpoint_permanent (b);
10424
10425 /* If possible, carry over 'disable' status from existing
10426 breakpoints. */
10427 {
10428 struct bp_location *e = existing_locations;
10429 /* If there are multiple breakpoints with the same function name,
10430 e.g. for inline functions, comparing function names won't work.
10431 Instead compare pc addresses; this is just a heuristic as things
10432 may have moved, but in practice it gives the correct answer
10433 often enough until a better solution is found. */
10434 int have_ambiguous_names = ambiguous_names_p (b->loc);
10435
10436 for (; e; e = e->next)
10437 {
10438 if (!e->enabled && e->function_name)
10439 {
10440 struct bp_location *l = b->loc;
10441 if (have_ambiguous_names)
10442 {
10443 for (; l; l = l->next)
10444 if (breakpoint_address_match (e->pspace->aspace, e->address,
10445 l->pspace->aspace, l->address))
10446 {
10447 l->enabled = 0;
10448 break;
10449 }
10450 }
10451 else
10452 {
10453 for (; l; l = l->next)
10454 if (l->function_name
10455 && strcmp (e->function_name, l->function_name) == 0)
10456 {
10457 l->enabled = 0;
10458 break;
10459 }
10460 }
10461 }
10462 }
10463 }
10464
10465 update_global_location_list (1);
10466 }
10467
10468 /* Reset a breakpoint given it's struct breakpoint * BINT.
10469 The value we return ends up being the return value from catch_errors.
10470 Unused in this case. */
10471
10472 static int
10473 breakpoint_re_set_one (void *bint)
10474 {
10475 /* Get past catch_errs. */
10476 struct breakpoint *b = (struct breakpoint *) bint;
10477 int not_found = 0;
10478 int *not_found_ptr = &not_found;
10479 struct symtabs_and_lines sals = {0};
10480 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded = {0};
10481 char *s;
10482 struct gdb_exception e;
10483 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL);
10484 int marker_spec = 0;
10485
10486 switch (b->type)
10487 {
10488 case bp_none:
10489 warning (_("attempted to reset apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
10490 b->number);
10491 return 0;
10492 case bp_breakpoint:
10493 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
10494 case bp_tracepoint:
10495 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
10496 case bp_static_tracepoint:
10497 /* Do not attempt to re-set breakpoints disabled during startup. */
10498 if (b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled)
10499 return 0;
10500
10501 if (b->addr_string == NULL)
10502 {
10503 /* Anything without a string can't be re-set. */
10504 delete_breakpoint (b);
10505 return 0;
10506 }
10507
10508 input_radix = b->input_radix;
10509 s = b->addr_string;
10510
10511 save_current_space_and_thread ();
10512 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (b->pspace);
10513
10514 marker_spec = b->type == bp_static_tracepoint && is_marker_spec (s);
10515
10516 set_language (b->language);
10517 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
10518 {
10519 if (marker_spec)
10520 {
10521 sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (&s);
10522 if (sals.nelts > b->static_trace_marker_id_idx)
10523 {
10524 sals.sals[0] = sals.sals[b->static_trace_marker_id_idx];
10525 sals.nelts = 1;
10526 }
10527 else
10528 error (_("marker %s not found"), b->static_trace_marker_id);
10529 }
10530 else
10531 sals = decode_line_1 (&s, 1, (struct symtab *) NULL, 0,
10532 (char ***) NULL, not_found_ptr);
10533 }
10534 if (e.reason < 0)
10535 {
10536 int not_found_and_ok = 0;
10537 /* For pending breakpoints, it's expected that parsing will
10538 fail until the right shared library is loaded. User has
10539 already told to create pending breakpoints and don't need
10540 extra messages. If breakpoint is in bp_shlib_disabled
10541 state, then user already saw the message about that
10542 breakpoint being disabled, and don't want to see more
10543 errors. */
10544 if (not_found
10545 && (b->condition_not_parsed
10546 || (b->loc && b->loc->shlib_disabled)
10547 || b->enable_state == bp_disabled))
10548 not_found_and_ok = 1;
10549
10550 if (!not_found_and_ok)
10551 {
10552 /* We surely don't want to warn about the same breakpoint
10553 10 times. One solution, implemented here, is disable
10554 the breakpoint on error. Another solution would be to
10555 have separate 'warning emitted' flag. Since this
10556 happens only when a binary has changed, I don't know
10557 which approach is better. */
10558 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
10559 throw_exception (e);
10560 }
10561 }
10562
10563 if (!not_found)
10564 {
10565 gdb_assert (sals.nelts == 1);
10566
10567 resolve_sal_pc (&sals.sals[0]);
10568 if (b->condition_not_parsed && s && s[0])
10569 {
10570 char *cond_string = 0;
10571 int thread = -1;
10572 int task = 0;
10573
10574 find_condition_and_thread (s, sals.sals[0].pc,
10575 &cond_string, &thread, &task);
10576 if (cond_string)
10577 b->cond_string = cond_string;
10578 b->thread = thread;
10579 b->task = task;
10580 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
10581 }
10582
10583 if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint && !marker_spec)
10584 sals.sals[0] = update_static_tracepoint (b, sals.sals[0]);
10585
10586 expanded = expand_line_sal_maybe (sals.sals[0]);
10587 }
10588
10589 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
10590 update_breakpoint_locations (b, expanded);
10591 break;
10592
10593 case bp_watchpoint:
10594 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10595 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10596 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10597 /* Watchpoint can be either on expression using entirely global
10598 variables, or it can be on local variables.
10599
10600 Watchpoints of the first kind are never auto-deleted, and
10601 even persist across program restarts. Since they can use
10602 variables from shared libraries, we need to reparse
10603 expression as libraries are loaded and unloaded.
10604
10605 Watchpoints on local variables can also change meaning as
10606 result of solib event. For example, if a watchpoint uses
10607 both a local and a global variables in expression, it's a
10608 local watchpoint, but unloading of a shared library will make
10609 the expression invalid. This is not a very common use case,
10610 but we still re-evaluate expression, to avoid surprises to
10611 the user.
10612
10613 Note that for local watchpoints, we re-evaluate it only if
10614 watchpoints frame id is still valid. If it's not, it means
10615 the watchpoint is out of scope and will be deleted soon. In
10616 fact, I'm not sure we'll ever be called in this case.
10617
10618 If a local watchpoint's frame id is still valid, then
10619 b->exp_valid_block is likewise valid, and we can safely use it.
10620
10621 Don't do anything about disabled watchpoints, since they will
10622 be reevaluated again when enabled. */
10623 update_watchpoint (b, 1 /* reparse */);
10624 break;
10625 /* We needn't really do anything to reset these, since the mask
10626 that requests them is unaffected by e.g., new libraries being
10627 loaded. */
10628 case bp_catchpoint:
10629 break;
10630
10631 default:
10632 printf_filtered (_("Deleting unknown breakpoint type %d\n"), b->type);
10633 /* fall through */
10634 /* Delete overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints; they will be
10635 reset later by breakpoint_re_set. */
10636 case bp_overlay_event:
10637 case bp_longjmp_master:
10638 case bp_std_terminate_master:
10639 case bp_exception_master:
10640 delete_breakpoint (b);
10641 break;
10642
10643 /* This breakpoint is special, it's set up when the inferior
10644 starts and we really don't want to touch it. */
10645 case bp_shlib_event:
10646
10647 /* Like bp_shlib_event, this breakpoint type is special.
10648 Once it is set up, we do not want to touch it. */
10649 case bp_thread_event:
10650
10651 /* Keep temporary breakpoints, which can be encountered when we
10652 step over a dlopen call and SOLIB_ADD is resetting the
10653 breakpoints. Otherwise these should have been blown away via
10654 the cleanup chain or by breakpoint_init_inferior when we
10655 rerun the executable. */
10656 case bp_until:
10657 case bp_finish:
10658 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
10659 case bp_call_dummy:
10660 case bp_std_terminate:
10661 case bp_step_resume:
10662 case bp_longjmp:
10663 case bp_longjmp_resume:
10664 case bp_exception:
10665 case bp_exception_resume:
10666 case bp_jit_event:
10667 break;
10668 }
10669
10670 do_cleanups (cleanups);
10671 return 0;
10672 }
10673
10674 /* Re-set all breakpoints after symbols have been re-loaded. */
10675 void
10676 breakpoint_re_set (void)
10677 {
10678 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
10679 enum language save_language;
10680 int save_input_radix;
10681 struct cleanup *old_chain;
10682
10683 save_language = current_language->la_language;
10684 save_input_radix = input_radix;
10685 old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
10686
10687 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
10688 {
10689 /* Format possible error msg. */
10690 char *message = xstrprintf ("Error in re-setting breakpoint %d: ",
10691 b->number);
10692 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, message);
10693 catch_errors (breakpoint_re_set_one, b, message, RETURN_MASK_ALL);
10694 do_cleanups (cleanups);
10695 }
10696 set_language (save_language);
10697 input_radix = save_input_radix;
10698
10699 jit_breakpoint_re_set ();
10700
10701 do_cleanups (old_chain);
10702
10703 create_overlay_event_breakpoint ();
10704 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ();
10705 create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint ();
10706 create_exception_master_breakpoint ();
10707 }
10708 \f
10709 /* Reset the thread number of this breakpoint:
10710
10711 - If the breakpoint is for all threads, leave it as-is.
10712 - Else, reset it to the current thread for inferior_ptid. */
10713 void
10714 breakpoint_re_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b)
10715 {
10716 if (b->thread != -1)
10717 {
10718 if (in_thread_list (inferior_ptid))
10719 b->thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
10720
10721 /* We're being called after following a fork. The new fork is
10722 selected as current, and unless this was a vfork will have a
10723 different program space from the original thread. Reset that
10724 as well. */
10725 b->loc->pspace = current_program_space;
10726 }
10727 }
10728
10729 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
10730 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
10731 which ends with a period (no newline). */
10732
10733 void
10734 set_ignore_count (int bptnum, int count, int from_tty)
10735 {
10736 struct breakpoint *b;
10737
10738 if (count < 0)
10739 count = 0;
10740
10741 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
10742 if (b->number == bptnum)
10743 {
10744 if (is_tracepoint (b))
10745 {
10746 if (from_tty && count != 0)
10747 printf_filtered (_("Ignore count ignored for tracepoint %d."),
10748 bptnum);
10749 return;
10750 }
10751
10752 b->ignore_count = count;
10753 if (from_tty)
10754 {
10755 if (count == 0)
10756 printf_filtered (_("Will stop next time "
10757 "breakpoint %d is reached."),
10758 bptnum);
10759 else if (count == 1)
10760 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next crossing of breakpoint %d."),
10761 bptnum);
10762 else
10763 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next %d "
10764 "crossings of breakpoint %d."),
10765 count, bptnum);
10766 }
10767 breakpoints_changed ();
10768 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
10769 return;
10770 }
10771
10772 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bptnum);
10773 }
10774
10775 /* Command to set ignore-count of breakpoint N to COUNT. */
10776
10777 static void
10778 ignore_command (char *args, int from_tty)
10779 {
10780 char *p = args;
10781 int num;
10782
10783 if (p == 0)
10784 error_no_arg (_("a breakpoint number"));
10785
10786 num = get_number (&p);
10787 if (num == 0)
10788 error (_("bad breakpoint number: '%s'"), args);
10789 if (*p == 0)
10790 error (_("Second argument (specified ignore-count) is missing."));
10791
10792 set_ignore_count (num,
10793 longest_to_int (value_as_long (parse_and_eval (p))),
10794 from_tty);
10795 if (from_tty)
10796 printf_filtered ("\n");
10797 }
10798 \f
10799 /* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints
10800 whose numbers are given in ARGS. */
10801
10802 static void
10803 map_breakpoint_numbers (char *args, void (*function) (struct breakpoint *,
10804 void *),
10805 void *data)
10806 {
10807 int num;
10808 struct breakpoint *b, *tmp;
10809 int match;
10810 struct get_number_or_range_state state;
10811
10812 if (args == 0)
10813 error_no_arg (_("one or more breakpoint numbers"));
10814
10815 init_number_or_range (&state, args);
10816
10817 while (!state.finished)
10818 {
10819 char *p = state.string;
10820
10821 match = 0;
10822
10823 num = get_number_or_range (&state);
10824 if (num == 0)
10825 {
10826 warning (_("bad breakpoint number at or near '%s'"), p);
10827 }
10828 else
10829 {
10830 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, tmp)
10831 if (b->number == num)
10832 {
10833 struct breakpoint *related_breakpoint = b->related_breakpoint;
10834 match = 1;
10835 function (b, data);
10836 if (related_breakpoint)
10837 function (related_breakpoint, data);
10838 break;
10839 }
10840 if (match == 0)
10841 printf_unfiltered (_("No breakpoint number %d.\n"), num);
10842 }
10843 }
10844 }
10845
10846 static struct bp_location *
10847 find_location_by_number (char *number)
10848 {
10849 char *dot = strchr (number, '.');
10850 char *p1;
10851 int bp_num;
10852 int loc_num;
10853 struct breakpoint *b;
10854 struct bp_location *loc;
10855
10856 *dot = '\0';
10857
10858 p1 = number;
10859 bp_num = get_number (&p1);
10860 if (bp_num == 0)
10861 error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%s'"), number);
10862
10863 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
10864 if (b->number == bp_num)
10865 {
10866 break;
10867 }
10868
10869 if (!b || b->number != bp_num)
10870 error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%s'"), number);
10871
10872 p1 = dot+1;
10873 loc_num = get_number (&p1);
10874 if (loc_num == 0)
10875 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%s'"), number);
10876
10877 --loc_num;
10878 loc = b->loc;
10879 for (;loc_num && loc; --loc_num, loc = loc->next)
10880 ;
10881 if (!loc)
10882 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%s'"), dot+1);
10883
10884 return loc;
10885 }
10886
10887
10888 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
10889 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
10890 which ends with a period (no newline). */
10891
10892 void
10893 disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
10894 {
10895 /* Never disable a watchpoint scope breakpoint; we want to
10896 hit them when we leave scope so we can delete both the
10897 watchpoint and its scope breakpoint at that time. */
10898 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
10899 return;
10900
10901 /* You can't disable permanent breakpoints. */
10902 if (bpt->enable_state == bp_permanent)
10903 return;
10904
10905 bpt->enable_state = bp_disabled;
10906
10907 update_global_location_list (0);
10908
10909 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bpt->number);
10910 }
10911
10912 /* A callback for map_breakpoint_numbers that calls
10913 disable_breakpoint. */
10914
10915 static void
10916 do_map_disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, void *ignore)
10917 {
10918 disable_breakpoint (b);
10919 }
10920
10921 static void
10922 disable_command (char *args, int from_tty)
10923 {
10924 struct breakpoint *bpt;
10925
10926 if (args == 0)
10927 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
10928 switch (bpt->type)
10929 {
10930 case bp_none:
10931 warning (_("attempted to disable apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
10932 bpt->number);
10933 break;
10934 case bp_breakpoint:
10935 case bp_tracepoint:
10936 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
10937 case bp_static_tracepoint:
10938 case bp_catchpoint:
10939 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
10940 case bp_watchpoint:
10941 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10942 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10943 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10944 disable_breakpoint (bpt);
10945 break;
10946 default:
10947 break;
10948 }
10949 else if (strchr (args, '.'))
10950 {
10951 struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (args);
10952 if (loc)
10953 loc->enabled = 0;
10954 update_global_location_list (0);
10955 }
10956 else
10957 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, do_map_disable_breakpoint, NULL);
10958 }
10959
10960 static void
10961 do_enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, enum bpdisp disposition)
10962 {
10963 int target_resources_ok;
10964
10965 if (bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
10966 {
10967 int i;
10968 i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
10969 target_resources_ok =
10970 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
10971 i + 1, 0);
10972 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
10973 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
10974 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
10975 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
10976 }
10977
10978 if (is_watchpoint (bpt))
10979 {
10980 struct gdb_exception e;
10981
10982 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
10983 {
10984 update_watchpoint (bpt, 1 /* reparse */);
10985 }
10986 if (e.reason < 0)
10987 {
10988 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, e, _("Cannot enable watchpoint %d: "),
10989 bpt->number);
10990 return;
10991 }
10992 }
10993
10994 if (bpt->enable_state != bp_permanent)
10995 bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
10996 bpt->disposition = disposition;
10997 update_global_location_list (1);
10998 breakpoints_changed ();
10999
11000 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bpt->number);
11001 }
11002
11003
11004 void
11005 enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
11006 {
11007 do_enable_breakpoint (bpt, bpt->disposition);
11008 }
11009
11010 /* A callback for map_breakpoint_numbers that calls
11011 enable_breakpoint. */
11012
11013 static void
11014 do_map_enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, void *ignore)
11015 {
11016 enable_breakpoint (b);
11017 }
11018
11019 /* The enable command enables the specified breakpoints (or all defined
11020 breakpoints) so they once again become (or continue to be) effective
11021 in stopping the inferior. */
11022
11023 static void
11024 enable_command (char *args, int from_tty)
11025 {
11026 struct breakpoint *bpt;
11027
11028 if (args == 0)
11029 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
11030 switch (bpt->type)
11031 {
11032 case bp_none:
11033 warning (_("attempted to enable apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
11034 bpt->number);
11035 break;
11036 case bp_breakpoint:
11037 case bp_tracepoint:
11038 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
11039 case bp_static_tracepoint:
11040 case bp_catchpoint:
11041 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
11042 case bp_watchpoint:
11043 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
11044 case bp_read_watchpoint:
11045 case bp_access_watchpoint:
11046 enable_breakpoint (bpt);
11047 break;
11048 default:
11049 break;
11050 }
11051 else if (strchr (args, '.'))
11052 {
11053 struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (args);
11054 if (loc)
11055 loc->enabled = 1;
11056 update_global_location_list (1);
11057 }
11058 else
11059 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, do_map_enable_breakpoint, NULL);
11060 }
11061
11062 static void
11063 enable_once_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, void *ignore)
11064 {
11065 do_enable_breakpoint (bpt, disp_disable);
11066 }
11067
11068 static void
11069 enable_once_command (char *args, int from_tty)
11070 {
11071 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, enable_once_breakpoint, NULL);
11072 }
11073
11074 static void
11075 enable_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, void *ignore)
11076 {
11077 do_enable_breakpoint (bpt, disp_del);
11078 }
11079
11080 static void
11081 enable_delete_command (char *args, int from_tty)
11082 {
11083 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, enable_delete_breakpoint, NULL);
11084 }
11085 \f
11086 static void
11087 set_breakpoint_cmd (char *args, int from_tty)
11088 {
11089 }
11090
11091 static void
11092 show_breakpoint_cmd (char *args, int from_tty)
11093 {
11094 }
11095
11096 /* Invalidate last known value of any hardware watchpoint if
11097 the memory which that value represents has been written to by
11098 GDB itself. */
11099
11100 static void
11101 invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change (CORE_ADDR addr, int len,
11102 const bfd_byte *data)
11103 {
11104 struct breakpoint *bp;
11105
11106 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bp)
11107 if (bp->enable_state == bp_enabled
11108 && bp->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
11109 && bp->val_valid && bp->val)
11110 {
11111 struct bp_location *loc;
11112
11113 for (loc = bp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
11114 if (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
11115 && loc->address + loc->length > addr
11116 && addr + len > loc->address)
11117 {
11118 value_free (bp->val);
11119 bp->val = NULL;
11120 bp->val_valid = 0;
11121 }
11122 }
11123 }
11124
11125 /* Use default_breakpoint_'s, or nothing if they aren't valid. */
11126
11127 struct symtabs_and_lines
11128 decode_line_spec_1 (char *string, int funfirstline)
11129 {
11130 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
11131
11132 if (string == 0)
11133 error (_("Empty line specification."));
11134 if (default_breakpoint_valid)
11135 sals = decode_line_1 (&string, funfirstline,
11136 default_breakpoint_symtab,
11137 default_breakpoint_line,
11138 (char ***) NULL, NULL);
11139 else
11140 sals = decode_line_1 (&string, funfirstline,
11141 (struct symtab *) NULL, 0, (char ***) NULL, NULL);
11142 if (*string)
11143 error (_("Junk at end of line specification: %s"), string);
11144 return sals;
11145 }
11146
11147 /* Create and insert a raw software breakpoint at PC. Return an
11148 identifier, which should be used to remove the breakpoint later.
11149 In general, places which call this should be using something on the
11150 breakpoint chain instead; this function should be eliminated
11151 someday. */
11152
11153 void *
11154 deprecated_insert_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
11155 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
11156 {
11157 struct bp_target_info *bp_tgt;
11158
11159 bp_tgt = XZALLOC (struct bp_target_info);
11160
11161 bp_tgt->placed_address_space = aspace;
11162 bp_tgt->placed_address = pc;
11163
11164 if (target_insert_breakpoint (gdbarch, bp_tgt) != 0)
11165 {
11166 /* Could not insert the breakpoint. */
11167 xfree (bp_tgt);
11168 return NULL;
11169 }
11170
11171 return bp_tgt;
11172 }
11173
11174 /* Remove a breakpoint BP inserted by
11175 deprecated_insert_raw_breakpoint. */
11176
11177 int
11178 deprecated_remove_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, void *bp)
11179 {
11180 struct bp_target_info *bp_tgt = bp;
11181 int ret;
11182
11183 ret = target_remove_breakpoint (gdbarch, bp_tgt);
11184 xfree (bp_tgt);
11185
11186 return ret;
11187 }
11188
11189 /* One (or perhaps two) breakpoints used for software single
11190 stepping. */
11191
11192 static void *single_step_breakpoints[2];
11193 static struct gdbarch *single_step_gdbarch[2];
11194
11195 /* Create and insert a breakpoint for software single step. */
11196
11197 void
11198 insert_single_step_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
11199 struct address_space *aspace,
11200 CORE_ADDR next_pc)
11201 {
11202 void **bpt_p;
11203
11204 if (single_step_breakpoints[0] == NULL)
11205 {
11206 bpt_p = &single_step_breakpoints[0];
11207 single_step_gdbarch[0] = gdbarch;
11208 }
11209 else
11210 {
11211 gdb_assert (single_step_breakpoints[1] == NULL);
11212 bpt_p = &single_step_breakpoints[1];
11213 single_step_gdbarch[1] = gdbarch;
11214 }
11215
11216 /* NOTE drow/2006-04-11: A future improvement to this function would
11217 be to only create the breakpoints once, and actually put them on
11218 the breakpoint chain. That would let us use set_raw_breakpoint.
11219 We could adjust the addresses each time they were needed. Doing
11220 this requires corresponding changes elsewhere where single step
11221 breakpoints are handled, however. So, for now, we use this. */
11222
11223 *bpt_p = deprecated_insert_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, aspace, next_pc);
11224 if (*bpt_p == NULL)
11225 error (_("Could not insert single-step breakpoint at %s"),
11226 paddress (gdbarch, next_pc));
11227 }
11228
11229 /* Check if the breakpoints used for software single stepping
11230 were inserted or not. */
11231
11232 int
11233 single_step_breakpoints_inserted (void)
11234 {
11235 return (single_step_breakpoints[0] != NULL
11236 || single_step_breakpoints[1] != NULL);
11237 }
11238
11239 /* Remove and delete any breakpoints used for software single step. */
11240
11241 void
11242 remove_single_step_breakpoints (void)
11243 {
11244 gdb_assert (single_step_breakpoints[0] != NULL);
11245
11246 /* See insert_single_step_breakpoint for more about this deprecated
11247 call. */
11248 deprecated_remove_raw_breakpoint (single_step_gdbarch[0],
11249 single_step_breakpoints[0]);
11250 single_step_gdbarch[0] = NULL;
11251 single_step_breakpoints[0] = NULL;
11252
11253 if (single_step_breakpoints[1] != NULL)
11254 {
11255 deprecated_remove_raw_breakpoint (single_step_gdbarch[1],
11256 single_step_breakpoints[1]);
11257 single_step_gdbarch[1] = NULL;
11258 single_step_breakpoints[1] = NULL;
11259 }
11260 }
11261
11262 /* Delete software single step breakpoints without removing them from
11263 the inferior. This is intended to be used if the inferior's address
11264 space where they were inserted is already gone, e.g. after exit or
11265 exec. */
11266
11267 void
11268 cancel_single_step_breakpoints (void)
11269 {
11270 int i;
11271
11272 for (i = 0; i < 2; i++)
11273 if (single_step_breakpoints[i])
11274 {
11275 xfree (single_step_breakpoints[i]);
11276 single_step_breakpoints[i] = NULL;
11277 single_step_gdbarch[i] = NULL;
11278 }
11279 }
11280
11281 /* Detach software single-step breakpoints from INFERIOR_PTID without
11282 removing them. */
11283
11284 static void
11285 detach_single_step_breakpoints (void)
11286 {
11287 int i;
11288
11289 for (i = 0; i < 2; i++)
11290 if (single_step_breakpoints[i])
11291 target_remove_breakpoint (single_step_gdbarch[i],
11292 single_step_breakpoints[i]);
11293 }
11294
11295 /* Check whether a software single-step breakpoint is inserted at
11296 PC. */
11297
11298 static int
11299 single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace,
11300 CORE_ADDR pc)
11301 {
11302 int i;
11303
11304 for (i = 0; i < 2; i++)
11305 {
11306 struct bp_target_info *bp_tgt = single_step_breakpoints[i];
11307 if (bp_tgt
11308 && breakpoint_address_match (bp_tgt->placed_address_space,
11309 bp_tgt->placed_address,
11310 aspace, pc))
11311 return 1;
11312 }
11313
11314 return 0;
11315 }
11316
11317 /* Returns 0 if 'bp' is NOT a syscall catchpoint,
11318 non-zero otherwise. */
11319 static int
11320 is_syscall_catchpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *bp)
11321 {
11322 if (syscall_catchpoint_p (bp)
11323 && bp->enable_state != bp_disabled
11324 && bp->enable_state != bp_call_disabled)
11325 return 1;
11326 else
11327 return 0;
11328 }
11329
11330 int
11331 catch_syscall_enabled (void)
11332 {
11333 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
11334
11335 return inf->total_syscalls_count != 0;
11336 }
11337
11338 int
11339 catching_syscall_number (int syscall_number)
11340 {
11341 struct breakpoint *bp;
11342
11343 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bp)
11344 if (is_syscall_catchpoint_enabled (bp))
11345 {
11346 if (bp->syscalls_to_be_caught)
11347 {
11348 int i, iter;
11349 for (i = 0;
11350 VEC_iterate (int, bp->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
11351 i++)
11352 if (syscall_number == iter)
11353 return 1;
11354 }
11355 else
11356 return 1;
11357 }
11358
11359 return 0;
11360 }
11361
11362 /* Complete syscall names. Used by "catch syscall". */
11363 static char **
11364 catch_syscall_completer (struct cmd_list_element *cmd,
11365 char *text, char *word)
11366 {
11367 const char **list = get_syscall_names ();
11368 char **retlist
11369 = (list == NULL) ? NULL : complete_on_enum (list, text, word);
11370
11371 xfree (list);
11372 return retlist;
11373 }
11374
11375 /* Tracepoint-specific operations. */
11376
11377 /* Set tracepoint count to NUM. */
11378 static void
11379 set_tracepoint_count (int num)
11380 {
11381 tracepoint_count = num;
11382 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("tpnum"), num);
11383 }
11384
11385 void
11386 trace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
11387 {
11388 if (create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
11389 arg,
11390 NULL, 0, 1 /* parse arg */,
11391 0 /* tempflag */,
11392 bp_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
11393 0 /* Ignore count */,
11394 pending_break_support,
11395 NULL,
11396 from_tty,
11397 1 /* enabled */,
11398 0 /* internal */))
11399 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
11400 }
11401
11402 void
11403 ftrace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
11404 {
11405 if (create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
11406 arg,
11407 NULL, 0, 1 /* parse arg */,
11408 0 /* tempflag */,
11409 bp_fast_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
11410 0 /* Ignore count */,
11411 pending_break_support,
11412 NULL,
11413 from_tty,
11414 1 /* enabled */,
11415 0 /* internal */))
11416 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
11417 }
11418
11419 /* strace command implementation. Creates a static tracepoint. */
11420
11421 void
11422 strace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
11423 {
11424 if (create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
11425 arg,
11426 NULL, 0, 1 /* parse arg */,
11427 0 /* tempflag */,
11428 bp_static_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
11429 0 /* Ignore count */,
11430 pending_break_support,
11431 NULL,
11432 from_tty,
11433 1 /* enabled */,
11434 0 /* internal */))
11435 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
11436 }
11437
11438 /* Set up a fake reader function that gets command lines from a linked
11439 list that was acquired during tracepoint uploading. */
11440
11441 static struct uploaded_tp *this_utp;
11442 static int next_cmd;
11443
11444 static char *
11445 read_uploaded_action (void)
11446 {
11447 char *rslt;
11448
11449 VEC_iterate (char_ptr, this_utp->cmd_strings, next_cmd, rslt);
11450
11451 next_cmd++;
11452
11453 return rslt;
11454 }
11455
11456 /* Given information about a tracepoint as recorded on a target (which
11457 can be either a live system or a trace file), attempt to create an
11458 equivalent GDB tracepoint. This is not a reliable process, since
11459 the target does not necessarily have all the information used when
11460 the tracepoint was originally defined. */
11461
11462 struct breakpoint *
11463 create_tracepoint_from_upload (struct uploaded_tp *utp)
11464 {
11465 char *addr_str, small_buf[100];
11466 struct breakpoint *tp;
11467
11468 if (utp->at_string)
11469 addr_str = utp->at_string;
11470 else
11471 {
11472 /* In the absence of a source location, fall back to raw
11473 address. Since there is no way to confirm that the address
11474 means the same thing as when the trace was started, warn the
11475 user. */
11476 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d has no "
11477 "source location, using raw address"),
11478 utp->number);
11479 sprintf (small_buf, "*%s", hex_string (utp->addr));
11480 addr_str = small_buf;
11481 }
11482
11483 /* There's not much we can do with a sequence of bytecodes. */
11484 if (utp->cond && !utp->cond_string)
11485 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d condition "
11486 "has no source form, ignoring it"),
11487 utp->number);
11488
11489 if (!create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
11490 addr_str,
11491 utp->cond_string, -1, 0 /* parse cond/thread */,
11492 0 /* tempflag */,
11493 utp->type /* type_wanted */,
11494 0 /* Ignore count */,
11495 pending_break_support,
11496 NULL,
11497 0 /* from_tty */,
11498 utp->enabled /* enabled */,
11499 0 /* internal */))
11500 return NULL;
11501
11502 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
11503
11504 /* Get the tracepoint we just created. */
11505 tp = get_tracepoint (tracepoint_count);
11506 gdb_assert (tp != NULL);
11507
11508 if (utp->pass > 0)
11509 {
11510 sprintf (small_buf, "%d %d", utp->pass, tp->number);
11511
11512 trace_pass_command (small_buf, 0);
11513 }
11514
11515 /* If we have uploaded versions of the original commands, set up a
11516 special-purpose "reader" function and call the usual command line
11517 reader, then pass the result to the breakpoint command-setting
11518 function. */
11519 if (!VEC_empty (char_ptr, utp->cmd_strings))
11520 {
11521 struct command_line *cmd_list;
11522
11523 this_utp = utp;
11524 next_cmd = 0;
11525
11526 cmd_list = read_command_lines_1 (read_uploaded_action, 1, NULL, NULL);
11527
11528 breakpoint_set_commands (tp, cmd_list);
11529 }
11530 else if (!VEC_empty (char_ptr, utp->actions)
11531 || !VEC_empty (char_ptr, utp->step_actions))
11532 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d actions "
11533 "have no source form, ignoring them"),
11534 utp->number);
11535
11536 return tp;
11537 }
11538
11539 /* Print information on tracepoint number TPNUM_EXP, or all if
11540 omitted. */
11541
11542 static void
11543 tracepoints_info (char *args, int from_tty)
11544 {
11545 int num_printed;
11546
11547 num_printed = breakpoint_1 (args, 0, is_tracepoint);
11548
11549 if (num_printed == 0)
11550 {
11551 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
11552 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No tracepoints.\n");
11553 else
11554 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No tracepoint matching '%s'.\n", args);
11555 }
11556
11557 default_collect_info ();
11558 }
11559
11560 /* The 'enable trace' command enables tracepoints.
11561 Not supported by all targets. */
11562 static void
11563 enable_trace_command (char *args, int from_tty)
11564 {
11565 enable_command (args, from_tty);
11566 }
11567
11568 /* The 'disable trace' command disables tracepoints.
11569 Not supported by all targets. */
11570 static void
11571 disable_trace_command (char *args, int from_tty)
11572 {
11573 disable_command (args, from_tty);
11574 }
11575
11576 /* Remove a tracepoint (or all if no argument). */
11577 static void
11578 delete_trace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
11579 {
11580 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
11581
11582 dont_repeat ();
11583
11584 if (arg == 0)
11585 {
11586 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
11587
11588 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument.
11589 Do not delete internal or call-dummy breakpoints, these
11590 have to be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number
11591 argument. */
11592 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
11593 {
11594 if (b->number >= 0)
11595 {
11596 breaks_to_delete = 1;
11597 break;
11598 }
11599 }
11600
11601 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
11602 if (!from_tty
11603 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all tracepoints? "))))
11604 {
11605 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
11606 {
11607 if (is_tracepoint (b)
11608 && b->number >= 0)
11609 delete_breakpoint (b);
11610 }
11611 }
11612 }
11613 else
11614 map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, do_delete_breakpoint, NULL);
11615 }
11616
11617 /* Helper function for trace_pass_command. */
11618
11619 static void
11620 trace_pass_set_count (struct breakpoint *bp, int count, int from_tty)
11621 {
11622 bp->pass_count = count;
11623 observer_notify_tracepoint_modified (bp->number);
11624 if (from_tty)
11625 printf_filtered (_("Setting tracepoint %d's passcount to %d\n"),
11626 bp->number, count);
11627 }
11628
11629 /* Set passcount for tracepoint.
11630
11631 First command argument is passcount, second is tracepoint number.
11632 If tracepoint number omitted, apply to most recently defined.
11633 Also accepts special argument "all". */
11634
11635 static void
11636 trace_pass_command (char *args, int from_tty)
11637 {
11638 struct breakpoint *t1;
11639 unsigned int count;
11640
11641 if (args == 0 || *args == 0)
11642 error (_("passcount command requires an "
11643 "argument (count + optional TP num)"));
11644
11645 count = strtoul (args, &args, 10); /* Count comes first, then TP num. */
11646
11647 while (*args && isspace ((int) *args))
11648 args++;
11649
11650 if (*args && strncasecmp (args, "all", 3) == 0)
11651 {
11652 args += 3; /* Skip special argument "all". */
11653 if (*args)
11654 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11655
11656 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t1)
11657 {
11658 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
11659 }
11660 }
11661 else if (*args == '\0')
11662 {
11663 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, NULL, 1);
11664 if (t1)
11665 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
11666 }
11667 else
11668 {
11669 struct get_number_or_range_state state;
11670
11671 init_number_or_range (&state, args);
11672 while (!state.finished)
11673 {
11674 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, &state, 1);
11675 if (t1)
11676 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
11677 }
11678 }
11679 }
11680
11681 struct breakpoint *
11682 get_tracepoint (int num)
11683 {
11684 struct breakpoint *t;
11685
11686 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
11687 if (t->number == num)
11688 return t;
11689
11690 return NULL;
11691 }
11692
11693 /* Find the tracepoint with the given target-side number (which may be
11694 different from the tracepoint number after disconnecting and
11695 reconnecting). */
11696
11697 struct breakpoint *
11698 get_tracepoint_by_number_on_target (int num)
11699 {
11700 struct breakpoint *t;
11701
11702 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
11703 if (t->number_on_target == num)
11704 return t;
11705
11706 return NULL;
11707 }
11708
11709 /* Utility: parse a tracepoint number and look it up in the list.
11710 If STATE is not NULL, use, get_number_or_range_state and ignore ARG.
11711 If OPTIONAL_P is true, then if the argument is missing, the most
11712 recent tracepoint (tracepoint_count) is returned. */
11713 struct breakpoint *
11714 get_tracepoint_by_number (char **arg,
11715 struct get_number_or_range_state *state,
11716 int optional_p)
11717 {
11718 extern int tracepoint_count;
11719 struct breakpoint *t;
11720 int tpnum;
11721 char *instring = arg == NULL ? NULL : *arg;
11722
11723 if (state)
11724 {
11725 gdb_assert (!state->finished);
11726 tpnum = get_number_or_range (state);
11727 }
11728 else if (arg == NULL || *arg == NULL || ! **arg)
11729 {
11730 if (optional_p)
11731 tpnum = tracepoint_count;
11732 else
11733 error_no_arg (_("tracepoint number"));
11734 }
11735 else
11736 tpnum = get_number (arg);
11737
11738 if (tpnum <= 0)
11739 {
11740 if (instring && *instring)
11741 printf_filtered (_("bad tracepoint number at or near '%s'\n"),
11742 instring);
11743 else
11744 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoint argument missing "
11745 "and no previous tracepoint\n"));
11746 return NULL;
11747 }
11748
11749 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
11750 if (t->number == tpnum)
11751 {
11752 return t;
11753 }
11754
11755 printf_unfiltered ("No tracepoint number %d.\n", tpnum);
11756 return NULL;
11757 }
11758
11759 /* Save information on user settable breakpoints (watchpoints, etc) to
11760 a new script file named FILENAME. If FILTER is non-NULL, call it
11761 on each breakpoint and only include the ones for which it returns
11762 non-zero. */
11763
11764 static void
11765 save_breakpoints (char *filename, int from_tty,
11766 int (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *))
11767 {
11768 struct breakpoint *tp;
11769 int any = 0;
11770 char *pathname;
11771 struct cleanup *cleanup;
11772 struct ui_file *fp;
11773 int extra_trace_bits = 0;
11774
11775 if (filename == 0 || *filename == 0)
11776 error (_("Argument required (file name in which to save)"));
11777
11778 /* See if we have anything to save. */
11779 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (tp)
11780 {
11781 /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints. */
11782 if (!user_breakpoint_p (tp))
11783 continue;
11784
11785 /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts. */
11786 if (filter && !filter (tp))
11787 continue;
11788
11789 any = 1;
11790
11791 if (is_tracepoint (tp))
11792 {
11793 extra_trace_bits = 1;
11794
11795 /* We can stop searching. */
11796 break;
11797 }
11798 }
11799
11800 if (!any)
11801 {
11802 warning (_("Nothing to save."));
11803 return;
11804 }
11805
11806 pathname = tilde_expand (filename);
11807 cleanup = make_cleanup (xfree, pathname);
11808 fp = gdb_fopen (pathname, "w");
11809 if (!fp)
11810 error (_("Unable to open file '%s' for saving (%s)"),
11811 filename, safe_strerror (errno));
11812 make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (fp);
11813
11814 if (extra_trace_bits)
11815 save_trace_state_variables (fp);
11816
11817 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (tp)
11818 {
11819 /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints. */
11820 if (!user_breakpoint_p (tp))
11821 continue;
11822
11823 /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts. */
11824 if (filter && !filter (tp))
11825 continue;
11826
11827 if (tp->ops != NULL)
11828 (tp->ops->print_recreate) (tp, fp);
11829 else
11830 {
11831 if (tp->type == bp_fast_tracepoint)
11832 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "ftrace");
11833 if (tp->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
11834 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "strace");
11835 else if (tp->type == bp_tracepoint)
11836 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "trace");
11837 else if (tp->type == bp_breakpoint && tp->disposition == disp_del)
11838 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "tbreak");
11839 else if (tp->type == bp_breakpoint)
11840 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "break");
11841 else if (tp->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
11842 && tp->disposition == disp_del)
11843 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "thbreak");
11844 else if (tp->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
11845 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "hbreak");
11846 else if (tp->type == bp_watchpoint)
11847 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "watch");
11848 else if (tp->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
11849 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "watch");
11850 else if (tp->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
11851 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "rwatch");
11852 else if (tp->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
11853 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "awatch");
11854 else
11855 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
11856 _("unhandled breakpoint type %d"), (int) tp->type);
11857
11858 if (tp->exp_string)
11859 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", tp->exp_string);
11860 else if (tp->addr_string)
11861 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", tp->addr_string);
11862 else
11863 {
11864 char tmp[40];
11865
11866 sprintf_vma (tmp, tp->loc->address);
11867 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " *0x%s", tmp);
11868 }
11869 }
11870
11871 if (tp->thread != -1)
11872 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " thread %d", tp->thread);
11873
11874 if (tp->task != 0)
11875 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " task %d", tp->task);
11876
11877 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "\n");
11878
11879 /* Note, we can't rely on tp->number for anything, as we can't
11880 assume the recreated breakpoint numbers will match. Use $bpnum
11881 instead. */
11882
11883 if (tp->cond_string)
11884 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " condition $bpnum %s\n", tp->cond_string);
11885
11886 if (tp->ignore_count)
11887 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " ignore $bpnum %d\n", tp->ignore_count);
11888
11889 if (tp->pass_count)
11890 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " passcount %d\n", tp->pass_count);
11891
11892 if (tp->commands)
11893 {
11894 volatile struct gdb_exception ex;
11895
11896 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " commands\n");
11897
11898 ui_out_redirect (uiout, fp);
11899 TRY_CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
11900 {
11901 print_command_lines (uiout, tp->commands->commands, 2);
11902 }
11903 ui_out_redirect (uiout, NULL);
11904
11905 if (ex.reason < 0)
11906 throw_exception (ex);
11907
11908 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " end\n");
11909 }
11910
11911 if (tp->enable_state == bp_disabled)
11912 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "disable\n");
11913
11914 /* If this is a multi-location breakpoint, check if the locations
11915 should be individually disabled. Watchpoint locations are
11916 special, and not user visible. */
11917 if (!is_watchpoint (tp) && tp->loc && tp->loc->next)
11918 {
11919 struct bp_location *loc;
11920 int n = 1;
11921
11922 for (loc = tp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next, n++)
11923 if (!loc->enabled)
11924 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "disable $bpnum.%d\n", n);
11925 }
11926 }
11927
11928 if (extra_trace_bits && *default_collect)
11929 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "set default-collect %s\n", default_collect);
11930
11931 do_cleanups (cleanup);
11932 if (from_tty)
11933 printf_filtered (_("Saved to file '%s'.\n"), filename);
11934 }
11935
11936 /* The `save breakpoints' command. */
11937
11938 static void
11939 save_breakpoints_command (char *args, int from_tty)
11940 {
11941 save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, NULL);
11942 }
11943
11944 /* The `save tracepoints' command. */
11945
11946 static void
11947 save_tracepoints_command (char *args, int from_tty)
11948 {
11949 save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, is_tracepoint);
11950 }
11951
11952 /* Create a vector of all tracepoints. */
11953
11954 VEC(breakpoint_p) *
11955 all_tracepoints ()
11956 {
11957 VEC(breakpoint_p) *tp_vec = 0;
11958 struct breakpoint *tp;
11959
11960 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp)
11961 {
11962 VEC_safe_push (breakpoint_p, tp_vec, tp);
11963 }
11964
11965 return tp_vec;
11966 }
11967
11968 \f
11969 /* This help string is used for the break, hbreak, tbreak and thbreak
11970 commands. It is defined as a macro to prevent duplication.
11971 COMMAND should be a string constant containing the name of the
11972 command. */
11973 #define BREAK_ARGS_HELP(command) \
11974 command" [LOCATION] [thread THREADNUM] [if CONDITION]\n\
11975 LOCATION may be a line number, function name, or \"*\" and an address.\n\
11976 If a line number is specified, break at start of code for that line.\n\
11977 If a function is specified, break at start of code for that function.\n\
11978 If an address is specified, break at that exact address.\n\
11979 With no LOCATION, uses current execution address of the selected\n\
11980 stack frame. This is useful for breaking on return to a stack frame.\n\
11981 \n\
11982 THREADNUM is the number from \"info threads\".\n\
11983 CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
11984 \n\
11985 Multiple breakpoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\
11986 conditions are different.\n\
11987 \n\
11988 Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints."
11989
11990 /* List of subcommands for "catch". */
11991 static struct cmd_list_element *catch_cmdlist;
11992
11993 /* List of subcommands for "tcatch". */
11994 static struct cmd_list_element *tcatch_cmdlist;
11995
11996 /* Like add_cmd, but add the command to both the "catch" and "tcatch"
11997 lists, and pass some additional user data to the command function. */
11998 static void
11999 add_catch_command (char *name, char *docstring,
12000 void (*sfunc) (char *args, int from_tty,
12001 struct cmd_list_element *command),
12002 char **(*completer) (struct cmd_list_element *cmd,
12003 char *text, char *word),
12004 void *user_data_catch,
12005 void *user_data_tcatch)
12006 {
12007 struct cmd_list_element *command;
12008
12009 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, NULL, docstring,
12010 &catch_cmdlist);
12011 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
12012 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_catch);
12013 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
12014
12015 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, NULL, docstring,
12016 &tcatch_cmdlist);
12017 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
12018 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_tcatch);
12019 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
12020 }
12021
12022 static void
12023 clear_syscall_counts (struct inferior *inf)
12024 {
12025 inf->total_syscalls_count = 0;
12026 inf->any_syscall_count = 0;
12027 VEC_free (int, inf->syscalls_counts);
12028 }
12029
12030 static void
12031 save_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
12032 {
12033 printf_unfiltered (_("\"save\" must be followed by "
12034 "the name of a save subcommand.\n"));
12035 help_list (save_cmdlist, "save ", -1, gdb_stdout);
12036 }
12037
12038 struct breakpoint *
12039 iterate_over_breakpoints (int (*callback) (struct breakpoint *, void *),
12040 void *data)
12041 {
12042 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
12043
12044 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
12045 {
12046 if ((*callback) (b, data))
12047 return b;
12048 }
12049
12050 return NULL;
12051 }
12052
12053 void
12054 _initialize_breakpoint (void)
12055 {
12056 struct cmd_list_element *c;
12057
12058 observer_attach_solib_unloaded (disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib);
12059 observer_attach_inferior_exit (clear_syscall_counts);
12060 observer_attach_memory_changed (invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change);
12061
12062 breakpoint_objfile_key = register_objfile_data ();
12063
12064 breakpoint_chain = 0;
12065 /* Don't bother to call set_breakpoint_count. $bpnum isn't useful
12066 before a breakpoint is set. */
12067 breakpoint_count = 0;
12068
12069 tracepoint_count = 0;
12070
12071 add_com ("ignore", class_breakpoint, ignore_command, _("\
12072 Set ignore-count of breakpoint number N to COUNT.\n\
12073 Usage is `ignore N COUNT'."));
12074 if (xdb_commands)
12075 add_com_alias ("bc", "ignore", class_breakpoint, 1);
12076
12077 add_com ("commands", class_breakpoint, commands_command, _("\
12078 Set commands to be executed when a breakpoint is hit.\n\
12079 Give breakpoint number as argument after \"commands\".\n\
12080 With no argument, the targeted breakpoint is the last one set.\n\
12081 The commands themselves follow starting on the next line.\n\
12082 Type a line containing \"end\" to indicate the end of them.\n\
12083 Give \"silent\" as the first line to make the breakpoint silent;\n\
12084 then no output is printed when it is hit, except what the commands print."));
12085
12086 add_com ("condition", class_breakpoint, condition_command, _("\
12087 Specify breakpoint number N to break only if COND is true.\n\
12088 Usage is `condition N COND', where N is an integer and COND is an\n\
12089 expression to be evaluated whenever breakpoint N is reached."));
12090
12091 c = add_com ("tbreak", class_breakpoint, tbreak_command, _("\
12092 Set a temporary breakpoint.\n\
12093 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
12094 so it will be deleted when hit. Equivalent to \"break\" followed\n\
12095 by using \"enable delete\" on the breakpoint number.\n\
12096 \n"
12097 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("tbreak")));
12098 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
12099
12100 c = add_com ("hbreak", class_breakpoint, hbreak_command, _("\
12101 Set a hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
12102 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint requires hardware support,\n\
12103 some target hardware may not have this support.\n\
12104 \n"
12105 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("hbreak")));
12106 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
12107
12108 c = add_com ("thbreak", class_breakpoint, thbreak_command, _("\
12109 Set a temporary hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
12110 Like \"hbreak\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
12111 so it will be deleted when hit.\n\
12112 \n"
12113 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("thbreak")));
12114 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
12115
12116 add_prefix_cmd ("enable", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
12117 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
12118 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
12119 With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\
12120 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
12121 With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."),
12122 &enablelist, "enable ", 1, &cmdlist);
12123 if (xdb_commands)
12124 add_com ("ab", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
12125 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
12126 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
12127 With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\
12128 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
12129 With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."));
12130
12131 add_com_alias ("en", "enable", class_breakpoint, 1);
12132
12133 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
12134 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
12135 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
12136 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
12137 May be abbreviated to simply \"enable\".\n"),
12138 &enablebreaklist, "enable breakpoints ", 1, &enablelist);
12139
12140 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
12141 Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
12142 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
12143 &enablebreaklist);
12144
12145 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
12146 Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
12147 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
12148 &enablebreaklist);
12149
12150 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
12151 Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
12152 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
12153 &enablelist);
12154
12155 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
12156 Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
12157 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
12158 &enablelist);
12159
12160 add_prefix_cmd ("disable", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
12161 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
12162 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
12163 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
12164 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until reenabled."),
12165 &disablelist, "disable ", 1, &cmdlist);
12166 add_com_alias ("dis", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
12167 add_com_alias ("disa", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
12168 if (xdb_commands)
12169 add_com ("sb", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
12170 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
12171 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
12172 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
12173 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until reenabled."));
12174
12175 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, disable_command, _("\
12176 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
12177 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
12178 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
12179 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until reenabled.\n\
12180 This command may be abbreviated \"disable\"."),
12181 &disablelist);
12182
12183 add_prefix_cmd ("delete", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
12184 Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
12185 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
12186 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
12187 \n\
12188 Also a prefix command for deletion of other GDB objects.\n\
12189 The \"unset\" command is also an alias for \"delete\"."),
12190 &deletelist, "delete ", 1, &cmdlist);
12191 add_com_alias ("d", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
12192 add_com_alias ("del", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
12193 if (xdb_commands)
12194 add_com ("db", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
12195 Delete some breakpoints.\n\
12196 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
12197 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n"));
12198
12199 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, delete_command, _("\
12200 Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
12201 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
12202 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
12203 This command may be abbreviated \"delete\"."),
12204 &deletelist);
12205
12206 add_com ("clear", class_breakpoint, clear_command, _("\
12207 Clear breakpoint at specified line or function.\n\
12208 Argument may be line number, function name, or \"*\" and an address.\n\
12209 If line number is specified, all breakpoints in that line are cleared.\n\
12210 If function is specified, breakpoints at beginning of function are cleared.\n\
12211 If an address is specified, breakpoints at that address are cleared.\n\
12212 \n\
12213 With no argument, clears all breakpoints in the line that the selected frame\n\
12214 is executing in.\n\
12215 \n\
12216 See also the \"delete\" command which clears breakpoints by number."));
12217 add_com_alias ("cl", "clear", class_breakpoint, 1);
12218
12219 c = add_com ("break", class_breakpoint, break_command, _("\
12220 Set breakpoint at specified line or function.\n"
12221 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("break")));
12222 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
12223
12224 add_com_alias ("b", "break", class_run, 1);
12225 add_com_alias ("br", "break", class_run, 1);
12226 add_com_alias ("bre", "break", class_run, 1);
12227 add_com_alias ("brea", "break", class_run, 1);
12228
12229 if (xdb_commands)
12230 add_com_alias ("ba", "break", class_breakpoint, 1);
12231
12232 if (dbx_commands)
12233 {
12234 add_abbrev_prefix_cmd ("stop", class_breakpoint, stop_command, _("\
12235 Break in function/address or break at a line in the current file."),
12236 &stoplist, "stop ", 1, &cmdlist);
12237 add_cmd ("in", class_breakpoint, stopin_command,
12238 _("Break in function or address."), &stoplist);
12239 add_cmd ("at", class_breakpoint, stopat_command,
12240 _("Break at a line in the current file."), &stoplist);
12241 add_com ("status", class_info, breakpoints_info, _("\
12242 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
12243 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
12244 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
12245 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
12246 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
12247 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
12248 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
12249 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
12250 \n\
12251 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
12252 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
12253 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
12254 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
12255 breakpoint set."));
12256 }
12257
12258 add_info ("breakpoints", breakpoints_info, _("\
12259 Status of specified breakpoints (all user-settable breakpoints if no argument).\n\
12260 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
12261 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
12262 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
12263 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
12264 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
12265 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
12266 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
12267 \n\
12268 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
12269 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
12270 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
12271 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
12272 breakpoint set."));
12273
12274 add_info_alias ("b", "breakpoints", 1);
12275
12276 if (xdb_commands)
12277 add_com ("lb", class_breakpoint, breakpoints_info, _("\
12278 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
12279 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
12280 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
12281 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
12282 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
12283 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
12284 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
12285 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
12286 \n\
12287 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
12288 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
12289 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
12290 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
12291 breakpoint set."));
12292
12293 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_maintenance, maintenance_info_breakpoints, _("\
12294 Status of all breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
12295 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
12296 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
12297 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
12298 \tlongjmp - internal breakpoint used to step through longjmp()\n\
12299 \tlongjmp resume - internal breakpoint at the target of longjmp()\n\
12300 \tuntil - internal breakpoint used by the \"until\" command\n\
12301 \tfinish - internal breakpoint used by the \"finish\" command\n\
12302 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
12303 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
12304 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
12305 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
12306 \n\
12307 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
12308 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
12309 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
12310 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
12311 breakpoint set."),
12312 &maintenanceinfolist);
12313
12314 add_prefix_cmd ("catch", class_breakpoint, catch_command, _("\
12315 Set catchpoints to catch events."),
12316 &catch_cmdlist, "catch ",
12317 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
12318
12319 add_prefix_cmd ("tcatch", class_breakpoint, tcatch_command, _("\
12320 Set temporary catchpoints to catch events."),
12321 &tcatch_cmdlist, "tcatch ",
12322 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
12323
12324 /* Add catch and tcatch sub-commands. */
12325 add_catch_command ("catch", _("\
12326 Catch an exception, when caught.\n\
12327 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
12328 catch_catch_command,
12329 NULL,
12330 CATCH_PERMANENT,
12331 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
12332 add_catch_command ("throw", _("\
12333 Catch an exception, when thrown.\n\
12334 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
12335 catch_throw_command,
12336 NULL,
12337 CATCH_PERMANENT,
12338 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
12339 add_catch_command ("fork", _("Catch calls to fork."),
12340 catch_fork_command_1,
12341 NULL,
12342 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_permanent,
12343 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_temporary);
12344 add_catch_command ("vfork", _("Catch calls to vfork."),
12345 catch_fork_command_1,
12346 NULL,
12347 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_permanent,
12348 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_temporary);
12349 add_catch_command ("exec", _("Catch calls to exec."),
12350 catch_exec_command_1,
12351 NULL,
12352 CATCH_PERMANENT,
12353 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
12354 add_catch_command ("syscall", _("\
12355 Catch system calls by their names and/or numbers.\n\
12356 Arguments say which system calls to catch. If no arguments\n\
12357 are given, every system call will be caught.\n\
12358 Arguments, if given, should be one or more system call names\n\
12359 (if your system supports that), or system call numbers."),
12360 catch_syscall_command_1,
12361 catch_syscall_completer,
12362 CATCH_PERMANENT,
12363 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
12364 add_catch_command ("exception", _("\
12365 Catch Ada exceptions, when raised.\n\
12366 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
12367 catch_ada_exception_command,
12368 NULL,
12369 CATCH_PERMANENT,
12370 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
12371 add_catch_command ("assert", _("\
12372 Catch failed Ada assertions, when raised.\n\
12373 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
12374 catch_assert_command,
12375 NULL,
12376 CATCH_PERMANENT,
12377 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
12378
12379 c = add_com ("watch", class_breakpoint, watch_command, _("\
12380 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
12381 Usage: watch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
12382 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
12383 an expression changes.\n\
12384 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
12385 the memory to which it refers."));
12386 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
12387
12388 c = add_com ("rwatch", class_breakpoint, rwatch_command, _("\
12389 Set a read watchpoint for an expression.\n\
12390 Usage: rwatch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
12391 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
12392 an expression is read.\n\
12393 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
12394 the memory to which it refers."));
12395 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
12396
12397 c = add_com ("awatch", class_breakpoint, awatch_command, _("\
12398 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
12399 Usage: awatch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
12400 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
12401 an expression is either read or written.\n\
12402 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
12403 the memory to which it refers."));
12404 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
12405
12406 add_info ("watchpoints", watchpoints_info, _("\
12407 Status of specified watchpoints (all watchpoints if no argument)."));
12408
12409 /* XXX: cagney/2005-02-23: This should be a boolean, and should
12410 respond to changes - contrary to the description. */
12411 add_setshow_zinteger_cmd ("can-use-hw-watchpoints", class_support,
12412 &can_use_hw_watchpoints, _("\
12413 Set debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
12414 Show debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
12415 If zero, gdb will not use hardware for new watchpoints, even if\n\
12416 such is available. (However, any hardware watchpoints that were\n\
12417 created before setting this to nonzero, will continue to use watchpoint\n\
12418 hardware.)"),
12419 NULL,
12420 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints,
12421 &setlist, &showlist);
12422
12423 can_use_hw_watchpoints = 1;
12424
12425 /* Tracepoint manipulation commands. */
12426
12427 c = add_com ("trace", class_breakpoint, trace_command, _("\
12428 Set a tracepoint at specified line or function.\n\
12429 \n"
12430 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("trace") "\n\
12431 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
12432 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
12433
12434 add_com_alias ("tp", "trace", class_alias, 0);
12435 add_com_alias ("tr", "trace", class_alias, 1);
12436 add_com_alias ("tra", "trace", class_alias, 1);
12437 add_com_alias ("trac", "trace", class_alias, 1);
12438
12439 c = add_com ("ftrace", class_breakpoint, ftrace_command, _("\
12440 Set a fast tracepoint at specified line or function.\n\
12441 \n"
12442 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("ftrace") "\n\
12443 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
12444 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
12445
12446 c = add_com ("strace", class_breakpoint, strace_command, _("\
12447 Set a static tracepoint at specified line, function or marker.\n\
12448 \n\
12449 strace [LOCATION] [if CONDITION]\n\
12450 LOCATION may be a line number, function name, \"*\" and an address,\n\
12451 or -m MARKER_ID.\n\
12452 If a line number is specified, probe the marker at start of code\n\
12453 for that line. If a function is specified, probe the marker at start\n\
12454 of code for that function. If an address is specified, probe the marker\n\
12455 at that exact address. If a marker id is specified, probe the marker\n\
12456 with that name. With no LOCATION, uses current execution address of\n\
12457 the selected stack frame.\n\
12458 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action -- ``collect $_sdata''.\n\
12459 This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point call to the\n\
12460 tracing library. You can inspect it when analyzing the trace buffer,\n\
12461 by printing the $_sdata variable like any other convenience variable.\n\
12462 \n\
12463 CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
12464 \n\
12465 Multiple tracepoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\
12466 conditions are different.\n\
12467 \n\
12468 Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints.\n\
12469 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
12470 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
12471
12472 add_info ("tracepoints", tracepoints_info, _("\
12473 Status of specified tracepoints (all tracepoints if no argument).\n\
12474 Convenience variable \"$tpnum\" contains the number of the\n\
12475 last tracepoint set."));
12476
12477 add_info_alias ("tp", "tracepoints", 1);
12478
12479 add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, delete_trace_command, _("\
12480 Delete specified tracepoints.\n\
12481 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
12482 No argument means delete all tracepoints."),
12483 &deletelist);
12484
12485 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, disable_trace_command, _("\
12486 Disable specified tracepoints.\n\
12487 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
12488 No argument means disable all tracepoints."),
12489 &disablelist);
12490 deprecate_cmd (c, "disable");
12491
12492 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, enable_trace_command, _("\
12493 Enable specified tracepoints.\n\
12494 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
12495 No argument means enable all tracepoints."),
12496 &enablelist);
12497 deprecate_cmd (c, "enable");
12498
12499 add_com ("passcount", class_trace, trace_pass_command, _("\
12500 Set the passcount for a tracepoint.\n\
12501 The trace will end when the tracepoint has been passed 'count' times.\n\
12502 Usage: passcount COUNT TPNUM, where TPNUM may also be \"all\";\n\
12503 if TPNUM is omitted, passcount refers to the last tracepoint defined."));
12504
12505 add_prefix_cmd ("save", class_breakpoint, save_command,
12506 _("Save breakpoint definitions as a script."),
12507 &save_cmdlist, "save ",
12508 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
12509
12510 c = add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, save_breakpoints_command, _("\
12511 Save current breakpoint definitions as a script.\n\
12512 This includes all types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints,\n\
12513 catchpoints, tracepoints). Use the 'source' command in another debug\n\
12514 session to restore them."),
12515 &save_cmdlist);
12516 set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
12517
12518 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, save_tracepoints_command, _("\
12519 Save current tracepoint definitions as a script.\n\
12520 Use the 'source' command in another debug session to restore them."),
12521 &save_cmdlist);
12522 set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
12523
12524 c = add_com_alias ("save-tracepoints", "save tracepoints", class_trace, 0);
12525 deprecate_cmd (c, "save tracepoints");
12526
12527 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, set_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
12528 Breakpoint specific settings\n\
12529 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
12530 pending breakpoint behavior"),
12531 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist, "set breakpoint ",
12532 0/*allow-unknown*/, &setlist);
12533 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, show_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
12534 Breakpoint specific settings\n\
12535 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
12536 pending breakpoint behavior"),
12537 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist, "show breakpoint ",
12538 0/*allow-unknown*/, &showlist);
12539
12540 add_setshow_auto_boolean_cmd ("pending", no_class,
12541 &pending_break_support, _("\
12542 Set debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
12543 Show debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
12544 If on, an unrecognized breakpoint location will cause gdb to create a\n\
12545 pending breakpoint. If off, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in\n\
12546 an error. If auto, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in a\n\
12547 user-query to see if a pending breakpoint should be created."),
12548 NULL,
12549 show_pending_break_support,
12550 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
12551 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
12552
12553 pending_break_support = AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO;
12554
12555 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("auto-hw", no_class,
12556 &automatic_hardware_breakpoints, _("\
12557 Set automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
12558 Show automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
12559 If set, the debugger will automatically use hardware breakpoints for\n\
12560 breakpoints set with \"break\" but falling in read-only memory. If not set,\n\
12561 a warning will be emitted for such breakpoints."),
12562 NULL,
12563 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints,
12564 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
12565 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
12566
12567 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("always-inserted", class_support,
12568 always_inserted_enums, &always_inserted_mode, _("\
12569 Set mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
12570 Show mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
12571 When this mode is off, breakpoints are inserted in inferior when it is\n\
12572 resumed, and removed when execution stops. When this mode is on,\n\
12573 breakpoints are inserted immediately and removed only when the user\n\
12574 deletes the breakpoint. When this mode is auto (which is the default),\n\
12575 the behaviour depends on the non-stop setting (see help set non-stop).\n\
12576 In this case, if gdb is controlling the inferior in non-stop mode, gdb\n\
12577 behaves as if always-inserted mode is on; if gdb is controlling the\n\
12578 inferior in all-stop mode, gdb behaves as if always-inserted mode is off."),
12579 NULL,
12580 &show_always_inserted_mode,
12581 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
12582 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
12583
12584 automatic_hardware_breakpoints = 1;
12585
12586 observer_attach_about_to_proceed (breakpoint_about_to_proceed);
12587 }
This page took 0.296561 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.